blob: 141f12e975553ec010cf018ad10ce53be1f378dc [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6b07bf72013-12-17 00:45:49 +01007 2013/12/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100458 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200459 - node
460 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100461 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100462
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 * Performance tuning
464 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200465 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100466 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100467 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100468 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200469 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200470 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200471 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472 - noepoll
473 - nokqueue
474 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100475 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200476 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200477 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200478 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100479 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100480 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200481 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100482 - tune.maxaccept
483 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200484 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200485 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100486 - tune.rcvbuf.client
487 - tune.rcvbuf.server
488 - tune.sndbuf.client
489 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100490 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100491 - tune.ssl.lifetime
492 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100493 - tune.zlib.memlevel
494 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100495
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496 * Debugging
497 - debug
498 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499
500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200502------------------------------------
503
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200504ca-base <dir>
505 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200506 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
507 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200508
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509chroot <jail dir>
510 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
511 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
512 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
513 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
514 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
515 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100516
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100517cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
518 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
519 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
520 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
521 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
522 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
523 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
524 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
525 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
526 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
527 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
528 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
529 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
530 they overlap.
531
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200532crt-base <dir>
533 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
534 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
535 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537daemon
538 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
539 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
540 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
541
542gid <number>
543 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
544 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
545 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100546 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
547 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550group <group name>
551 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
552 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100553
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200554log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
556 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100557 configured with "log global".
558
559 <address> can be one of:
560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100561 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100562 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
563 port).
564
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100565 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
566 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
567 port).
568
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
570 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
571 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
572 writeable).
573
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100574 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
575 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
576 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
577 in Bourne shell.
578
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100579 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580
581 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
582 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
583 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
584
585 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200586 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
587 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
588 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
589 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
590 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
591 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200593 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100595log-send-hostname [<string>]
596 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
597 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
598 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
599 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
600 the logs.
601
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000602log-tag <string>
603 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
604 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
605 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
606 running on the same host.
607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608nbproc <number>
609 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
610 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
611 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
612 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
613 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
614
615pidfile <pidfile>
616 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
617 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
618 starting the process. See also "daemon".
619
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100620stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200621 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
622 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
623 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
624 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
625 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
626 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
627 the number of processes used.
628
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629ssl-server-verify [none|required]
630 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
631 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
632 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
633
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200634stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
635 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
636 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
637 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
638 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200639
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200640 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
641 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
642 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200643
644stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
645 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
646 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100647 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200648
649stats maxconn <connections>
650 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
651 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
652
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653uid <number>
654 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
655 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
656 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
657 one. See also "gid" and "user".
658
659ulimit-n <number>
660 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
661 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
662 option.
663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100664unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
665 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
666
667 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
668 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
669 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
670 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
671 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
672 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
673 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
674 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
675 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
676 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678user <user name>
679 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
680 See also "uid" and "group".
681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200682node <name>
683 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
684
685 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
686 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
687 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
688 traffic.
689
690description <text>
691 Add a text that describes the instance.
692
693 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
694 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
695 "<" and ">" characters.
696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006983.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699-----------------------
700
701maxconn <number>
702 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
703 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
704 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
705 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
706
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200707maxconnrate <number>
708 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
709 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
710 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
711 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
712 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
713 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
714 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
715 fairness.
716
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100717maxcomprate <number>
718 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
719 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
720 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
721 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
722 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
723 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
724 default value.
725
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100726maxcompcpuusage <number>
727 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
728 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
729 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
730 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
731 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
732 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
733 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
734 process down and from introducing high latencies.
735
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100736maxpipes <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
738 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
739 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
740 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
741 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
742 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
743
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200744maxsessrate <number>
745 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
746 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
747 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
748 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
749 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
750 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
751 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
752 fairness.
753
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200754maxsslconn <number>
755 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
756 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
757 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
758 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
759 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
760 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
761 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
762
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200763maxsslrate <number>
764 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
765 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
766 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
767 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
768 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
769 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
770 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
771 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
772 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
773 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
774
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100775maxzlibmem <number>
776 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
777 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
778 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100779 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
780 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
781 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
782
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783noepoll
784 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
785 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100786 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787
788nokqueue
789 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
790 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
791 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
792
793nopoll
794 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
795 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100796 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100797 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100799nosplice
800 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
801 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
802 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100803 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100804 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
805 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
806 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
807 "option splice-response".
808
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200809spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900810 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
811 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
812 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
813 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
814 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
815 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200817tune.bufsize <number>
818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400826 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
827 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
828 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200829
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200830tune.chksize <number>
831 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
832 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
833 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
834 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
835 checks whenever possible.
836
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100837tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
838 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
839 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
840 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
841 this value. The default value is 1.
842
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100843tune.http.cookielen <number>
844 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
845 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
846 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
847 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
848 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
849 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
850 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
851 to change this value.
852
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200853tune.http.maxhdr <number>
854 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
855 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
856 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
857 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
858 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
859 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
860 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
861 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
862 limit too high.
863
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100864tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100865 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
866 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
867 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
868 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
869 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
870 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
871 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
872 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
873 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
874 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100875
876tune.maxpollevents <number>
877 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
878 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
879 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
880 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
881 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
882
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200883tune.maxrewrite <number>
884 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
885 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
886 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
887 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
888 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
889 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
890 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
891 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
892 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
893 bufsize.
894
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200895tune.pipesize <number>
896 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
897 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
898 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
899 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
900 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
901 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
902
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100903tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
904tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
905 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
906 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
907 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
908 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
909 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
910 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
911 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
912
913tune.sndbuf.client <number>
914tune.sndbuf.server <number>
915 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
916 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
917 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
918 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
919 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
920 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
921 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
922 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
923 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
924 notifying haproxy again.
925
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100926tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100927 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
928 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
929 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
930 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
931 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
932 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
933 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
934 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
935 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100936 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
937 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100938
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100939tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
940 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
941 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
942 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
943 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
944 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
945 being used for too long.
946
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100947tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
948 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
949 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
950 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
951 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
952 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
953 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
954 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
955 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
956 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
957 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
958 best value.
959
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100960tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
961 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
962 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
963 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
964 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
965 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
966
967tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
968 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
969 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
970 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
971 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733.3. Debugging
974--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975
976debug
977 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
978 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
979 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
980 system startup.
981
982quiet
983 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
984 line argument "-q".
985
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009873.4. Userlists
988--------------
989It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
990http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
991it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
992
993userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100994 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100995 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
996
997group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100998 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100999 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1000 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1001
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001002user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1003 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001004 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1005 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001006 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1007 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001008 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
1009 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
1010
1011
1012 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001013 userlist L1
1014 group G1 users tiger,scott
1015 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001016
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001017 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1018 user scott insecure-password elgato
1019 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001020
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001021 userlist L2
1022 group G1
1023 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001024
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001025 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1026 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1027 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001028
1029 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001031
10323.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001033----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001034It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1035haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1036pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1037identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1038or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1039Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1040known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1041the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1042process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1043during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1044tables.
1045
1046peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001047 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001048 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1049
1050peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1051 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1052 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1053 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1054 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1055 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1056 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1057
1058 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1059 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1060
1061 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1062 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1063 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1064 across all peers.
1065
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001066 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1067 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1068 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1069
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001070 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001071 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001072 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1073 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1074 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001075
1076 backend mybackend
1077 mode tcp
1078 balance roundrobin
1079 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1080 stick on src
1081
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001082 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1083 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001084
1085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010864. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001088
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1090 - defaults <name>
1091 - frontend <name>
1092 - backend <name>
1093 - listen <name>
1094
1095A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1096its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1097section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099
1100A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1101connections.
1102
1103A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1104to forward incoming connections.
1105
1106A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1107parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1110'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1111case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1112
1113Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1114logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1115proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1116However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1117name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1118
1119Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1120and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001121bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001122protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1123modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1124arbitrary criteria.
1125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011274.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1128--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001130The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1131limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1132they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1133limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001135option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001136and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1137with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1138specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001140
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001141 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1142------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1143acl - X X X
1144appsession - - X X
1145backlog X X X -
1146balance X - X X
1147bind - X X -
1148bind-process X X X X
1149block - X X X
1150capture cookie - X X -
1151capture request header - X X -
1152capture response header - X X -
1153clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001154compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001155contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1156cookie X - X X
1157default-server X - X X
1158default_backend X X X -
1159description - X X X
1160disabled X X X X
1161dispatch - - X X
1162enabled X X X X
1163errorfile X X X X
1164errorloc X X X X
1165errorloc302 X X X X
1166-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1167errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001168force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169fullconn X - X X
1170grace X X X X
1171hash-type X - X X
1172http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001173http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001174http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001175http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001176http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001177tcp-check expect - - X X
1178tcp-check send - - X X
1179tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001180http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001181id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001182ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001183log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001184maxconn X X X -
1185mode X X X X
1186monitor fail - X X -
1187monitor-net X X X -
1188monitor-uri X X X -
1189option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1190option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1191option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1192option allbackups (*) X - X X
1193option checkcache (*) X - X X
1194option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1195option contstats (*) X X X -
1196option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1197option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1198option forceclose (*) X X X X
1199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1200option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001201option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001202option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001203option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001204option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1205option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1206option httpchk X - X X
1207option httpclose (*) X X X X
1208option httplog X X X X
1209option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001210option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001211option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001212option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1213option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1214option logasap (*) X X X -
1215option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001216option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001217option nolinger (*) X X X X
1218option originalto X X X X
1219option persist (*) X - X X
1220option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001221option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001222option smtpchk X - X X
1223option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1224option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1225option splice-request (*) X X X X
1226option splice-response (*) X X X X
1227option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1228option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1229-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001230option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001231option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1232option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1233option tcpka X X X X
1234option tcplog X X X X
1235option transparent (*) X - X X
1236persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1237rate-limit sessions X X X -
1238redirect - X X X
1239redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1240redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1241reqadd - X X X
1242reqallow - X X X
1243reqdel - X X X
1244reqdeny - X X X
1245reqiallow - X X X
1246reqidel - X X X
1247reqideny - X X X
1248reqipass - X X X
1249reqirep - X X X
1250reqisetbe - X X X
1251reqitarpit - X X X
1252reqpass - X X X
1253reqrep - X X X
1254-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1255reqsetbe - X X X
1256reqtarpit - X X X
1257retries X - X X
1258rspadd - X X X
1259rspdel - X X X
1260rspdeny - X X X
1261rspidel - X X X
1262rspideny - X X X
1263rspirep - X X X
1264rsprep - X X X
1265server - - X X
1266source X - X X
1267srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001268stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001269stats auth X - X X
1270stats enable X - X X
1271stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001272stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273stats realm X - X X
1274stats refresh X - X X
1275stats scope X - X X
1276stats show-desc X - X X
1277stats show-legends X - X X
1278stats show-node X - X X
1279stats uri X - X X
1280-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1281stick match - - X X
1282stick on - - X X
1283stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001284stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001285stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001286tcp-request connection - X X -
1287tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001288tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001289tcp-response content - - X X
1290tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001291timeout check X - X X
1292timeout client X X X -
1293timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1294timeout connect X - X X
1295timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1296timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1297timeout http-request X X X X
1298timeout queue X - X X
1299timeout server X - X X
1300timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001302timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001303transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001304unique-id-format X X X -
1305unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001307use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1309 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001310
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013124.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1313---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314
1315This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1316
1317
1318acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1319 Declare or complete an access list.
1320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1321 no | yes | yes | yes
1322 Example:
1323 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1324 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1325 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001327 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001328
1329
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001330appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1331 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001332 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1334 no | no | yes | yes
1335 Arguments :
1336 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1337 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1338
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001339 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340 checked in each cookie value.
1341
1342 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1343 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1344 milliseconds.
1345
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001346 request-learn
1347 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1348 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1349 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1350 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1351 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1352 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1353
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001354 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1355 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1356 data following this prefix.
1357
1358 Example :
1359 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1360
1361 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1362 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1363
1364 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1365 2 modes are currently supported :
1366 - path-parameters :
1367 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1368 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1369 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1370 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1371 - query-string :
1372 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1373 query string.
1374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001375 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1376 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1377 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1378 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001379 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1380 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1381 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001382 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1383 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1384
1385 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1386
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001387 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1388 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1389 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001391 Example :
1392 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1393
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001394 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1395 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001396
1397
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001398backlog <conns>
1399 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1401 yes | yes | yes | no
1402 Arguments :
1403 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1404 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001405 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001406
1407 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1408 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1409 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1410 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1411 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1412 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1413 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1414 backlog parameter.
1415
1416 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1417 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1418 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1419
1420 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1421
1422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001424balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001425 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1427 yes | no | yes | yes
1428 Arguments :
1429 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1430 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1431 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1432 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1433
1434 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1435 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1436 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1437 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001438 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001439 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001440 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1441 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1442 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1443 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1444 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1445 it, so that you don't worry.
1446
1447 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1448 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1449 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1450 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1451 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1452 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1453 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1454 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001455
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001456 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1457 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1458 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1459 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1460 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1461 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1462 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1463 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1464
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001465 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1466 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1467 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1468 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001469 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001470 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1471 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1472 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1473 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1474 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001475 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1476 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1477 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1478 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1479 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1480 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001481
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001482 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1483 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1484 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1485 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1486 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1487 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1488 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1489 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001490 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001492 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1493 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1494 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001496 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1497 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1498 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1499 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1500 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1501 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1502 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1503 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1504 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1505 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1506 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1507 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001509 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001510 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1511 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1512 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1513 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1514 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1515 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1516 URIs start with a leading "/".
1517
1518 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1519 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1520 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1521 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001523 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001524 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1525
1526 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001527 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1528 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1529 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1530 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1531 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1532 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1533 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1534 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1535 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1536 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1537 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1538 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1539 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1540 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1541 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1542 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1543 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1544 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1545 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001546
1547 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1548 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1549 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1550 server will receive the request.
1551
1552 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1553 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1554 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1555 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1556 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001557 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1558 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1559 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001560
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001561 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1562 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1563 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1564 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1565 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001567 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001568 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1569 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1570 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1571
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001572 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1573 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1574 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1575
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001576 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001577 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001578 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1579 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1580 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1581 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1582 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1583 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001584 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001585 used instead.
1586
1587 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1588 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1589 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1590 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1591
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001592 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1593 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1594 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1595
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001596 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001599 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1600 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001601
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001602 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001603 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001605 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1606 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1607 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001608
1609 Examples :
1610 balance roundrobin
1611 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001612 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001613 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1614 balance hdr(host)
1615 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001616
1617 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1618 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001620 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001621 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1622 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1623 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1624 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1625
1626 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1627 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1628 defaults to 16 kB.
1629
1630 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1631 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1632
1633 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1634 Round Robin.
1635
1636 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1637 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1638 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1639 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1640
1641 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1642
1643 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001644 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001645 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1646 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1647 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001648
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001649 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1650 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001651
1652
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001653bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1654bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1657 no | yes | yes | no
1658 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001659 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1660 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1661 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1662 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001663 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001664 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1665 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1666 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1667 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1668 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1669 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1670 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001671 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1672 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1673 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001674 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1675 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1676 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1677 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001678
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001679 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1680 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001681 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1682 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1683 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001684 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1685 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1686 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1687 the range.
1688
1689 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1690 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1691 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1692 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1693 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1694 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1695 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001696 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001697 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001698
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001699 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1700 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1701 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1702 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1703 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1704 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1705 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1706 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001708 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1709 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1710 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1711 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1714 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1715 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1716 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1717 in a frontend.
1718
1719 Example :
1720 listen http_proxy
1721 bind :80,:443
1722 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001723 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001725 listen http_https_proxy
1726 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001727 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001728
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001729 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1730 bind ipv6@:80
1731 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1732 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1733
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001734 listen external_bind_app1
1735 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1736
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001737 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001738 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739
1740
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001741bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001742 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1744 yes | yes | yes | yes
1745 Arguments :
1746 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1747 may be used to override a default value.
1748
1749 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1750 option may be combined with other numbers.
1751
1752 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1753 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1754 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1755 missing from all processes.
1756
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001757 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1758 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1759 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1760 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1761 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001762
1763 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1764 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1765 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1766 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1767 and 'even' instances.
1768
1769 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1770 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1771 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1772 32.
1773
1774 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1775 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1776
1777 Example :
1778 listen app_ip1
1779 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001780 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001781
1782 listen app_ip2
1783 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001784 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001785
1786 listen management
1787 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001788 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001789
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001790 listen management
1791 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1792 bind-process 1-4
1793
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001794 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1795
1796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797block { if | unless } <condition>
1798 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1800 no | yes | yes | yes
1801
1802 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1803 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001804 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001805 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1807 "block" statements per instance.
1808
1809 Example:
1810 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1811 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1812 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1813 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001815 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816
1817
1818capture cookie <name> len <length>
1819 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1821 no | yes | yes | no
1822 Arguments :
1823 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1824 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1825 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1826 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1827 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1828
1829 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1830 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1831 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1832 right if it exceeds <length>.
1833
1834 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1835 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1836 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1837 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1838
1839 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1840 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1841 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1842
1843 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1844 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1845 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001846 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1847 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1848 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849
1850 Example:
1851 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1852
1853 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001854 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001855
1856
1857capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001858 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1860 no | yes | yes | no
1861 Arguments :
1862 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001863 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001864 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1865 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1866 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1867
1868 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1869 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1870 it exceeds <length>.
1871
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001872 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1874 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001875 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1876 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1877 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1878 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001879 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001880 environments to find where the request came from.
1881
1882 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1883 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1884 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1885 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001886
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001887 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1888 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1889 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1890 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1891 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893 Example:
1894 capture request header Host len 15
1895 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1896 capture request header Referrer len 15
1897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001898 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899 about logging.
1900
1901
1902capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001903 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1905 no | yes | yes | no
1906 Arguments :
1907 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001908 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001909 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1910 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1911 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1912
1913 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1914 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1915 it exceeds <length>.
1916
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001917 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1919 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1920 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001921 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1922 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1923 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1924 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001926 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1927 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1928 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1929 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1930 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931
1932 Example:
1933 capture response header Content-length len 9
1934 capture response header Location len 15
1935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001936 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937 about logging.
1938
1939
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001940clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 yes | yes | yes | no
1944 Arguments :
1945 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1946 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1947 as explained at the top of this document.
1948
1949 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1950 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1951 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1952 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1953 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1954 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1955 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1956 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001957 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1959 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1960
1961 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1962 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1963 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1964 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1965 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1966 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1967
1968 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1969 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1970
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001971 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1972 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001974compression algo <algorithm> ...
1975compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001976compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001977 Enable HTTP compression.
1978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1979 yes | yes | yes | yes
1980 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001981 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1982 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1983 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1984
1985 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001986 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001987 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1988 data.
1989
1990 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1991 support for zlib was built in.
1992
1993 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1994 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1995 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1996 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1997 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1998 in.
1999
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002000 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002001 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002002 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2003 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2004 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2005 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2006 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002007
2008 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2009 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2010 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2011 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2012 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002013 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2014 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2015 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2016 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2017 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2018 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002019
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002020 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002021 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2022 "Accept-Encoding" header
2023 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002024 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002025 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2026 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002027 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2028 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2029 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2030 "multipart"
2031 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2032 header
2033 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2034 and later
2035 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2036 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002037
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002038 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2039 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002040
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002041 Examples :
2042 compression algo gzip
2043 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002045contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2048 yes | no | yes | yes
2049 Arguments :
2050 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2051 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2052 as explained at the top of this document.
2053
2054 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002055 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002056 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2058 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2059 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2060 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2061
2062 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2064 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2065 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2066 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2067 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2068
2069 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2070 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2071 instead.
2072
2073 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2074 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2075
2076
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002077cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002078 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2079 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2082 yes | no | yes | yes
2083 Arguments :
2084 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2085 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2086 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2087 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2088 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2089 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2090 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2091 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2092 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2093
2094 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2095 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2096 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2097 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2098 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2099 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2100 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2101 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2102 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2103 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2104 "insert" and "prefix".
2105
2106 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002107 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002108
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002109 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002110 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2111 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2112 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2113 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2114 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2115 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2116 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2117 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2118 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2119 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002120
2121 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2122 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2123 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2124 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2125 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2126 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2127 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2128 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2129 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2130 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002131 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2132 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2133 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002135 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2136 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2137 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002138 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2139 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2140 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2141 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002142 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2143 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2144 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
2146 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2147 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2148 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2149 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2150 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2151 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2152 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2153 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2154 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2155
2156 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2157 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2158 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2159 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2160 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2161 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2162 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2163 persistence cookie in the cache.
2164 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2165
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002166 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2167 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2168 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2169 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2170 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2171 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2172 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2173 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2174 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2175 they logout.
2176
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002177 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2178 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2179 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2180 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2181
2182 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2183 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2184 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2185 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2186 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2187 this attribute.
2188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002189 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002190 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002191 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2192 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2193 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2194 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2195 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2196 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002197
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002198 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2199 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2200 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2201 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2202 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2203 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2204 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2205 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2206 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2207 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2208 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2209 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2210 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2211 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2212 the site.
2213
2214 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2215 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2216 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2217 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2218 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2219 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2220 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2221 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2222 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2223 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2224 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2225 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2226 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2227 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2228 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2229 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002231 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2232 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2233 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2234 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236 Examples :
2237 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2238 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2239 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002240 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002242 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002243 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002246default-server [param*]
2247 Change default options for a server in a backend
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 yes | no | yes | yes
2250 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002251 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2252 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2253 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2254 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002255
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002256 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002257 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2258
2259 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002260
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262default_backend <backend>
2263 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2265 yes | yes | yes | no
2266 Arguments :
2267 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2268
2269 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2270 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2271 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2272 will catch all undetermined requests.
2273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274 Example :
2275
2276 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2277 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2278 default_backend dynamic
2279
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002280 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002283description <string>
2284 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2286 no | yes | yes | yes
2287 Arguments : string
2288
2289 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2290 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2291 it describes.
2292 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2293
2294
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002295disabled
2296 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2298 yes | yes | yes | yes
2299 Arguments : none
2300
2301 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2302 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2303 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2304 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2305 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2306 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2307 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2308
2309 See also : "enabled"
2310
2311
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002312dispatch <address>:<port>
2313 Set a default server address
2314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2315 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002316 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002317
2318 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2319 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2320 during start-up.
2321
2322 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2323 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2324 possible with normal servers.
2325
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002326 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002327 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2328 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2329 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2330 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2331
2332 See also : "server"
2333
2334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335enabled
2336 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2338 yes | yes | yes | yes
2339 Arguments : none
2340
2341 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2342 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2343
2344 See also : "disabled"
2345
2346
2347errorfile <code> <file>
2348 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2350 yes | yes | yes | yes
2351 Arguments :
2352 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002353 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
2355 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002356 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002358 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2359 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002360
2361 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2362 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2363 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2364
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002365 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2368 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2369 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2370 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2371
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002372 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2373 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2374 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2375 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2376 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2377 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2380 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2381 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002382 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2384
2385 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2386
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002387 Example :
2388 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2389 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2390 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2391
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002392
2393errorloc <code> <url>
2394errorloc302 <code> <url>
2395 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 yes | yes | yes | yes
2398 Arguments :
2399 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002400 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002401
2402 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2403 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2404 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2405 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2406 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2407
2408 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2409 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2410 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2411
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002412 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002414 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2415 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2416 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2417 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2418 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2419 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2420 request.
2421
2422 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2423
2424
2425errorloc303 <code> <url>
2426 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2428 yes | yes | yes | yes
2429 Arguments :
2430 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2431 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2432
2433 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2434 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2435 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2436 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2437 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2438
2439 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2440 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2441 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2442
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002443 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2444
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002445 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2446 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2447 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2448 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002449 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002450
2451 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2452
2453
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002454force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2455 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2457 no | yes | yes | yes
2458
2459 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2460 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2461 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2462 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2463 marked down for maintenance operations.
2464
2465 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2466 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2467 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2468 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2469 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2470 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2471 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2472 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2473 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2474
2475 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2476 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2477 is used.
2478
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002479 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002480 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002481
2482
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002483fullconn <conns>
2484 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2486 yes | no | yes | yes
2487 Arguments :
2488 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2489 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2490
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002491 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002493 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002494 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2495 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2496 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2497 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2498 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002499 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002500
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002501 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2502 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2503 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002505 Example :
2506 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2507 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2508 # connections.
2509 backend dynamic
2510 fullconn 10000
2511 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2512 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2513
2514 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2515
2516
2517grace <time>
2518 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002520 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002521 Arguments :
2522 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2523 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2524 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2525
2526 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2527 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002528 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002529 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2530
2531 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2532 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2533 simplify it.
2534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002536hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002537 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2539 yes | no | yes | yes
2540 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002541 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2542 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002543
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002544 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2545 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2546 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2547 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2548 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2549 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2550 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2551 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2552 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2553 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002554
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002555 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2556 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2557 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2558 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2559 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2560 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2561 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2562 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2563 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2564 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2565 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2566 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2567 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002568 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2569 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002570
2571 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2572
2573 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2574 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2575 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2576 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002577 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2578 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2579 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002580
2581 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2582 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002583 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2584 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2585 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2586 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2587
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002588 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2589 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2590 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2591 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2592 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2593 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2594 parameter.
2595
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002596 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2597
2598 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2599 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2600 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2601 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2602 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2603 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2604 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2605 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2606 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2607 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2608 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2609 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002610
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002611 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2612 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2613 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002614
2615 See also : "balance", "server"
2616
2617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618http-check disable-on-404
2619 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002621 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002622 Arguments : none
2623
2624 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2625 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2626 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2627 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2628 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2629 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2630 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2631 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002632 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2633 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2634 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2635
2636 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2637
2638
2639http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002640 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002642 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002643 Arguments :
2644 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2645 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002646 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002647 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2648 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2649 details on the supported keywords.
2650
2651 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2652 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2653 with the usual backslash ('\').
2654
2655 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2656 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2657 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2658 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2659 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2660
2661 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002662 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002663 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2664 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2665 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2666
2667 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002668 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002669 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2670 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2671 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2672 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2673
2674 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002675 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002676 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2677 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2678 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2679 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2680 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2681 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2682 trace).
2683
2684 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002685 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002686 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2687 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2688 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2689 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2690 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2691 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2692
2693 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2694 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2695 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2696 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2697 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2698 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2699 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2700 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2701
2702 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2703 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2704
2705 Examples :
2706 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002707 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002708
2709 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002710 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002711
2712 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002713 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002714
2715 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002716 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002718 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002719
2720
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002721http-check send-state
2722 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2724 yes | no | yes | yes
2725 Arguments : none
2726
2727 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2728 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2729 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2730 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2731 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2732
2733 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2734 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2735 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2736 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2737 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2738 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2739 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2740 checked in multiple backends.
2741
2742 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2743 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2744
2745 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2746 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2747 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2748 one fails.
2749
2750 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2751 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2752 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2753
2754 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2755 server's queue.
2756
2757 Example of a header received by the application server :
2758 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2759 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2760
2761 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2762
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002763http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002764 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002765 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2766 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002767 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002768 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2769
2770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 no | yes | yes | yes
2772
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002773 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2774 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2775 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2776 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2777 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002778
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002779 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2780 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2781 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2782
2783 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2784 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2785 are evaluated.
2786
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002787 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2788 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2789 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2790 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2791 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2792 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2793 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2794 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2795 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2796 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2797 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2798
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002799 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2800 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2801 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2802 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2803 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2804
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002805 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2806 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2807 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002808 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2809 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002810
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002811 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2812 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2813 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2814 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2815 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2816 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2817 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2818 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2819
2820 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2821 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2822 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2823 external users.
2824
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002825 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2826 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2827 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2828 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2829 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2830 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2831 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2832 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2833
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002834 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2835 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2836 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2837 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2838 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2839 another equipment.
2840
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002841 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2842 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2843 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2844 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2845 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2846 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2847 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2848 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2849
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002850 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2851 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2852 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2853 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2854 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2855 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2856 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2857 admin privileges.
2858
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002859 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2860
2861 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2862 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2863 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2864 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002865
2866 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002867 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2868 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2869 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002870
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002871 http-request allow if nagios
2872 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2873 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2874 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002876 Example:
2877 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002878 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002879
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002880 Example:
2881 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2882 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2883 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2884 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2885 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2886 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2887 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2888 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2889 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2890
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002891 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2892 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002893
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002894http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002895 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002896 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002898 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2899
2900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2901 no | yes | yes | yes
2902
2903 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2904 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2905 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2906 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2907 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2908 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2909
2910 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2911 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2912 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2913 current section.
2914
2915 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2916 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2917 rules are evaluated.
2918
2919 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2920 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2921 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2922 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2923 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2924 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2925 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2926
2927 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2928 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2929 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2930 external users.
2931
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002932 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2933 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2934 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2935 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2936 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2937 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2938 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2939 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2940
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002941 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2942 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2943 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2944 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2945 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2946 another equipment.
2947
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002948 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2949 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2950 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2951 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2952 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2953 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2954 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2955 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2956
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002957 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2958 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2959 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2960 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2961 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2962 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2963 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2964 admin privileges.
2965
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002966 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2967
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002968 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002969 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2970 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2971 rules.
2972
2973 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2974 ACL usage.
2975
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002976
2977tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2978 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 no | no | yes | yes
2981
2982 Arguments :
2983 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2984 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2985 binary.
2986 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2987 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2988 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2989
2990 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2991 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2992 with the usual backslash ('\').
2993 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2994 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2995 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2996 used upper or lower case.
2997
2998
2999 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3000
3001 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3002 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3003 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3004 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3005 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3006 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3007 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3008 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3009
3010 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3011 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3012 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3013 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3014 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3015 expression.
3016
3017 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3018 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3019 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3020 this exact hexadecimal string.
3021 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3022
3023 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3024 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3025 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3026 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3027 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3028 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3029 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3030 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3031 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3032 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3033 the null character.
3034
3035 Examples :
3036 # perform a POP check
3037 option tcp-check
3038 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3039
3040 # perform an IMAP check
3041 option tcp-check
3042 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3043
3044 # look for the redis master server
3045 option tcp-check
3046 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3047 tcp-check expect +PONG
3048 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3049 tcp-check expect string role:master
3050 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3051 tcp-check expect string +OK
3052
3053
3054 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3055 tune.chksize
3056
3057
3058tcp-check send <data>
3059 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3061 no | no | yes | yes
3062
3063 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3064 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3065
3066 Examples :
3067 # look for the redis master server
3068 option tcp-check
3069 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3070 tcp-check expect string role:master
3071
3072 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3073 tune.chksize
3074
3075
3076tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3077 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3078 tcp health check
3079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3080 no | no | yes | yes
3081
3082 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3083 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3084 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3085 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3086 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3087 hexadecimal string.
3088 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3089
3090 Examples :
3091 # redis check in binary
3092 option tcp-check
3093 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3094 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3095
3096
3097 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3098 tune.chksize
3099
3100
3101
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003102http-send-name-header [<header>]
3103 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3104
3105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3106 yes | no | yes | yes
3107
3108 Arguments :
3109
3110 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3111
3112 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3113 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3114 is added with the header string proved.
3115
3116 See also : "server"
3117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003118id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003119 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 no | yes | yes | yes
3122 Arguments : none
3123
3124 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3125 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3126 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003127
3128
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003129ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3130 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3132 no | yes | yes | yes
3133
3134 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3135 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3136 and running).
3137
3138 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3139 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3140 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3141 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3142 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3143
3144 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3145 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3146
3147 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3148 "unless" condition is met.
3149
3150 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3151
3152
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003153log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003154log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003155no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003156 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003159
3160 Prefix :
3161 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3162 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3163 prefix does not allow arguments.
3164
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003165 Arguments :
3166 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3167 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3168 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3169 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3170 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3171 parameter.
3172
3173 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3174 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3175
3176 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3177 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3178 standard syslog port).
3179
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003180 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3181 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3182 standard syslog port).
3183
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003184 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3185 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3186 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3187 appropriately writeable).
3188
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003189 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3190 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3191 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3192 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3193
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003194 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3195
3196 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3197 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3198 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3199
3200 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3201 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3202 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003203 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3204 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3205 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3206 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3207 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003208
3209 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3210
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003211 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3212 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3213 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003214
3215 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3216 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3217 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3218 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3219
3220 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3221 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003222
3223 Example :
3224 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003225 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3226 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003227 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3228
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003229
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003230log-format <string>
3231 Allows you to custom a log line.
3232
3233 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003235
3236maxconn <conns>
3237 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | yes | yes | no
3240 Arguments :
3241 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3242 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3243 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3244 closes.
3245
3246 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3247 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3248 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3249 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3250 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3251 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3252 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3253 properly tuned.
3254
3255 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3256 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3257 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3258
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003259 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3260
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3262
3263
3264mode { tcp|http|health }
3265 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3267 yes | yes | yes | yes
3268 Arguments :
3269 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3270 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3271 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3272 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3273
3274 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3275 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3276 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3277 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3278 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3279
3280 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003281 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3282 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3283 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3284 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3285 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3286 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3287 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003288
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003289 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3290 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3291 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003292
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003293 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003294 defaults http_instances
3295 mode http
3296
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003297 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003298
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003300monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003301 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3303 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003304 Arguments :
3305 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3306 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003307 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003308 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3309 backend and its backup.
3310
3311 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3312 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3313 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3314 servers in a list of backends.
3315
3316 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3317 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3318 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3319 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3320 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3321 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3322 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003323 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3324 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325
3326 Example:
3327 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003329 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3330 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3331 monitor-uri /site_alive
3332 monitor fail if site_dead
3333
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003334 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003335
3336
3337monitor-net <source>
3338 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3340 yes | yes | yes | no
3341 Arguments :
3342 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3343 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3344 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3345 followed by a mask.
3346
3347 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3348 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003349 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003350 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3351
3352 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3353 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3354 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3355 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003356 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3357 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3358 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003359
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003360 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3361 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3362 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3363 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3364 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3365 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003366
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003367 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3368 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003369
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003370 Example :
3371 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3372 frontend www
3373 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3374
3375 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3376
3377
3378monitor-uri <uri>
3379 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 yes | yes | yes | no
3382 Arguments :
3383 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3384 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3385
3386 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3387 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3388 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3389 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3390 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3391 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3392 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3393 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3394
3395 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3396 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3397 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3398 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3399 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3400 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3401
3402 Example :
3403 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3404 frontend www
3405 mode http
3406 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3407
3408 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003411option abortonclose
3412no option abortonclose
3413 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3415 yes | no | yes | yes
3416 Arguments : none
3417
3418 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3419 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3420 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3421 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003422 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003423 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3424 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3425 encountered while delivering the response.
3426
3427 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3428 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3429 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3430 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3431 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3432 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003433 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003434 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003435 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003436 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3437 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3438 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3439
3440 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3441 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3442 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3443 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3444 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3445 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3446 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3447 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003448 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003449
3450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3452
3453 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3454
3455
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003456option accept-invalid-http-request
3457no option accept-invalid-http-request
3458 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | yes | yes | no
3461 Arguments : none
3462
3463 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3464 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3465 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3466 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3467 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3468 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3469 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3470 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003471 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3472 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3473 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3474 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3475 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3476 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003477
3478 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3479 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3480 been confirmed.
3481
3482 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3483 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003484 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3485 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003486 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3487
3488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3490
3491 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3492 stats socket.
3493
3494
3495option accept-invalid-http-response
3496no option accept-invalid-http-response
3497 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3499 yes | no | yes | yes
3500 Arguments : none
3501
3502 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3503 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3504 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3505 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3506 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3507 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3508 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3509 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3510 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3511
3512 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3513 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3514 been confirmed.
3515
3516 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3517 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3518 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3519 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3520
3521 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3522 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3523
3524 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3525 stats socket.
3526
3527
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003528option allbackups
3529no option allbackups
3530 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | no | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : none
3534
3535 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3536 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3537 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3538 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3539 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3540 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3541 order between the backup servers anymore.
3542
3543 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3544 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3545
3546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3548
3549
3550option checkcache
3551no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003552 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3554 yes | no | yes | yes
3555 Arguments : none
3556
3557 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3558 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003559 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003560 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3561 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003562 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003563
3564 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003565 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003566 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003567 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3568 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003569 to the client are :
3570 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003571 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003572 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003573 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3574 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3575 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3576 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3577 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3578 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3579 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3580 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3581 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3582 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3583 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3584
3585 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003586 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003587 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003588 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003589 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3590
3591 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3592 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003593 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003594 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3595
3596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3598
3599
3600option clitcpka
3601no option clitcpka
3602 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | no
3605 Arguments : none
3606
3607 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3608 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3609 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3610 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3611
3612 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3613 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3614 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3615 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3616
3617 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3618 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3619 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3620 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3621 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3622
3623 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3624
3625 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3626 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3627 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3628
3629 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3630 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3631
3632 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3633
3634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635option contstats
3636 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | yes | yes | no
3639 Arguments : none
3640
3641 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3642 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3643 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3644 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3645 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3646 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3647 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3648
3649
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003650option dontlog-normal
3651no option dontlog-normal
3652 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | no
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3658 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3659 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3660 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3661 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3662 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3663 logged.
3664
3665 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3666 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3667 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003669 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003670 logging.
3671
3672
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003673option dontlognull
3674no option dontlognull
3675 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3677 yes | yes | yes | no
3678 Arguments : none
3679
3680 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3681 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3682 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3683 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3684 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3685 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3686 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3687
3688 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3689 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3690 would not be logged.
3691
3692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003695 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003696
3697
3698option forceclose
3699no option forceclose
3700 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003703 Arguments : none
3704
3705 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3706 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3707 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3708 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3709 global session times in the logs.
3710
3711 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003712 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003713 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3714 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3715 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3716 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003717
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003718 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3719 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3720 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3721
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003722 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3723 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3724
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003725 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003726
3727
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003728option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003729 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | yes | yes | yes
3732 Arguments :
3733 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3734 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003735 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003736 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003737
3738 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3739 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3740 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3741 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3742 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3743 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3744 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003745 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3746 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3747 possible that the client has already brought one.
3748
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003749 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003750 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003751 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3752 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003753 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3754 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003755
3756 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3757 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3758 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3759 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3760 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3761 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3762 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3763
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003764 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3765 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3766 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3767 are under the control of the end-user.
3768
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003769 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003770 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3771 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003772 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3773 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3774 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003775
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003776 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3777 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3778 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3779 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3780 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003781
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003782 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003783 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3784 frontend www
3785 mode http
3786 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3787
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003788 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3789 backend www
3790 mode http
3791 option forwardfor header X-Client
3792
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003793 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3794 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003795
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003796
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003797option http-keep-alive
3798no option http-keep-alive
3799 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | yes | yes | yes
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3805 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3806 "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client- and
3807 server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3808 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3809 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3810 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3811 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3812 situations where this option may be useful :
3813
3814 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3815 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3816
3817 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3818 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3819
3820 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3821 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3822 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3823 request.
3824
3825 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3826 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003827 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3828 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3829 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003830
3831 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3832 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3833
3834 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3835 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3836 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3837 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3838 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3839 not set.
3840
3841 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3842 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3843 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3844 have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
3845
3846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3848
3849 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003850 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3851 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003852
3853
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003854option http-no-delay
3855no option http-no-delay
3856 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | yes | yes | yes
3859 Arguments : none
3860
3861 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3862 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3863 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3864 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3865 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3866 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3867 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3868 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3869 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3870 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3871 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3872 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3873 affected.
3874
3875 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3876 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3877 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3878 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3879 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3880 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3881 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3882 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3883 latency environments.
3884
3885
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003886option http-pretend-keepalive
3887no option http-pretend-keepalive
3888 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3890 yes | yes | yes | yes
3891 Arguments : none
3892
3893 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3894 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3895 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3896 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3897 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3898 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3899 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3900 consider the response complete.
3901
3902 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3903 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3904 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3905 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3906 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3907 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3908
3909 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3910 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3911 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3912 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3913 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3914 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3915 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3916
3917 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3918 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003919 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003920 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3921 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003922
3923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3925
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003926 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3927 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003928
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003929
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003930option http-server-close
3931no option http-server-close
3932 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935 Arguments : none
3936
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003937 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3938 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3939 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3940 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3941 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3942 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3943 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3944 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3945 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3946 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3947 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3948 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003949
3950 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3951 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3952 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3953 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003954 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3955 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003956
3957 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3958 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003959 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3960 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3961 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003962
3963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3965
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003966 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003967 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3968 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003969
3970
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003971option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003972no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003973 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | no
3976 Arguments : none
3977
3978 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3979 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3980 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3981 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3982 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3983 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3984 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3985
3986 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3987 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3988 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3989 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3990 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3991 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3992 request along its whole life.
3993
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003994 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3995 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3996 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3997 front of an existing proxy.
3998
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003999 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4000
4001 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4002 http-server-close".
4003
4004
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004005option httpchk
4006option httpchk <uri>
4007option httpchk <method> <uri>
4008option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4009 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | no | yes | yes
4012 Arguments :
4013 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4014 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4015 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4016 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4017 ones.
4018
4019 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4020 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4021 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4022
4023 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4024 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4025 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4026 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4027 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4028
4029 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4030 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4031 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4032 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4033 the lack of any response.
4034
4035 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4036
4037 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4038 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4039 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4040
4041 Examples :
4042 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4043 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4044 backend https_relay
4045 mode tcp
4046 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4047 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4048
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004049 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4050 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4051 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004052
4053
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004054option httpclose
4055no option httpclose
4056 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4058 yes | yes | yes | yes
4059 Arguments : none
4060
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004061 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4062 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4063 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4064 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4065 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4066 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4067 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004068
4069 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004070 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004071 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4072 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4073 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4074 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4075 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004076
4077 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4078 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
4079 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004080 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
4081 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004082
4083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4085
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004086 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4087 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004088
4089
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004090option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004091 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004094 Arguments :
4095 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4096 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4097 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4098 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4099 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004100
4101 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4102 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4103 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4104 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4105 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4106 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4107 ports.
4108
4109 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4110
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4113 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4114 by default.
4115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004116 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004117
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004118
4119option http_proxy
4120no option http_proxy
4121 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | yes | yes | yes
4124 Arguments : none
4125
4126 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4127 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4128 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4129 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4130 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4131
4132 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4133 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4134 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4135 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004136 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004137 be analyzed.
4138
4139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4141
4142 Example :
4143 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4144 backend direct_forward
4145 option httpclose
4146 option http_proxy
4147
4148 See also : "option httpclose"
4149
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004150
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004151option independent-streams
4152no option independent-streams
4153 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4155 yes | yes | yes | yes
4156 Arguments : none
4157
4158 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4159 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4160 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4161 receive data or not.
4162
4163 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4164 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4165 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4166 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4167 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4168 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4169 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4170 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4171 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4172 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4173 socket buffers.
4174
4175 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4176 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4177 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4178 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4179 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4180
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004181 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4182 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4183 deprecated.
4184
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004185 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004186
4187
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004188option ldap-check
4189 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4191 yes | no | yes | yes
4192 Arguments : none
4193
4194 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4195 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4196 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4197 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4198
4199 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4200 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4201
4202 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4203 configure it.
4204
4205 Example :
4206 option ldap-check
4207
4208 See also : "option httpchk"
4209
4210
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004211option log-health-checks
4212no option log-health-checks
4213 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 yes | no | yes | yes
4216 Arguments : none
4217
4218 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4219 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4220 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4221 of additional information is limited.
4222
4223 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4224 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4225
4226 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4227
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004228
4229option log-separate-errors
4230no option log-separate-errors
4231 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4233 yes | yes | yes | no
4234 Arguments : none
4235
4236 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4237 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4238 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4239 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4240 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4241 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4242 provides very important information.
4243
4244 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4245 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4246 error logs.
4247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004248 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004249 logging.
4250
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004251
4252option logasap
4253no option logasap
4254 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 yes | yes | yes | no
4257 Arguments : none
4258
4259 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4260 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4261 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4262 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4263 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4264 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4265 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004266 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004267 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4268 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4269
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004270 Examples :
4271 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4272 mode http
4273 option httplog
4274 option logasap
4275 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4276
4277 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4278 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4279 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4280 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004282 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004283 logging.
4284
4285
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004286option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4287 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4289 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004290 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004291 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4292 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004293
4294 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4295 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4296 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4297 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4298 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4299 in the MySQL table, like this :
4300
4301 USE mysql;
4302 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4303 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4304
4305 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4306 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4307 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4308 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4309 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4310 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4311 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4312 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4313 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4314
4315 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4316 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004317
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004318 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004319
4320 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4321 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4322 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4323 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4324 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4325 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4326
4327 See also: "option httpchk"
4328
4329
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004330option nolinger
4331no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004332 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4334 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004335 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004336
4337 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4338 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4339 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4340 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4341 connections.
4342
4343 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4344 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4345 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4346 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4347 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4348 this too.
4349
4350 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4351 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4352 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4353
4354 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4355 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4356 for servers.
4357
4358 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4359 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4360
4361
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004362option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4363 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 yes | yes | yes | yes
4366 Arguments :
4367 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4368 matching <network>
4369 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4370 header name.
4371
4372 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4373 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4374 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4375 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4376 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4377 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4378 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4379 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4380 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4381 possible that the client has already brought one.
4382
4383 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4384 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4385 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4386 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4387 header and requires different one.
4388
4389 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4390 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4391 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4392 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4393 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4394 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4395 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4396
4397 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4398 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4399 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4400 both are defined.
4401
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004402 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4403 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4404 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4405 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4406 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004407
4408 Examples :
4409 # Original Destination address
4410 frontend www
4411 mode http
4412 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4413
4414 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4415 backend www
4416 mode http
4417 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4418
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004419 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4420 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004421
4422
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004423option persist
4424no option persist
4425 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4427 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004428 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004429
4430 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4431 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4432 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4433 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4434 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4435 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4436 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4437 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4438 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4439 redirected to another valid server.
4440
4441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4443
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004444 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004445
4446
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004447option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4448 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4450 yes | no | yes | yes
4451 Arguments :
4452 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4453 PostgreSQL server.
4454
4455 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4456 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4457 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4458 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4459
4460 See also: "option httpchk"
4461
4462
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004463option prefer-last-server
4464no option prefer-last-server
4465 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 yes | no | yes | yes
4468 Arguments : none
4469
4470 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4471 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4472 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4473 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4474 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4475 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4476 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4477 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4478 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004479 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4480 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4481 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4482 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4483 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4484 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4485 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004486
4487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4489
4490 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4491
4492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004493option redispatch
4494no option redispatch
4495 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4496 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004498 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004499
4500 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4501 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4502 be able to access the service anymore.
4503
4504 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4505 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4506
4507 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4508 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4509 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004511 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4512 "redisp" keywords.
4513
4514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4516
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004517 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004518
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004519
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004520option redis-check
4521 Use redis health checks for server testing
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | no | yes | yes
4524 Arguments : none
4525
4526 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4527 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4528 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4529 find the "+PONG" response message.
4530
4531 Example :
4532 option redis-check
4533
4534 See also : "option httpchk"
4535
4536
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004537option smtpchk
4538option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4539 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004543 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4544 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4545 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4546
4547 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4548 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4549 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4550
4551 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4552 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4553 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4554 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4555 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4556 dead server.
4557
4558 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4559 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4560 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4561 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4562
4563 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4564 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4565 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4566 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4567 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4568
4569 Example :
4570 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4571
4572 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004575option socket-stats
4576no option socket-stats
4577
4578 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 yes | yes | yes | no
4581
4582 Arguments : none
4583
4584
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004585option splice-auto
4586no option splice-auto
4587 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4589 yes | yes | yes | yes
4590 Arguments : none
4591
4592 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4593 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4594 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4595 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004596 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004597 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4598 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4599 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4600 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4601
4602 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4603 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4604 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4605 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4606 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4607 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4608 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4609 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4610 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4611 keyword.
4612
4613 Example :
4614 option splice-auto
4615
4616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4618
4619 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4620 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4621
4622
4623option splice-request
4624no option splice-request
4625 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4627 yes | yes | yes | yes
4628 Arguments : none
4629
4630 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004631 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004632 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4633 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4634 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4635 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4636
4637 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4638
4639 Example :
4640 option splice-request
4641
4642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4644
4645 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4646 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4647
4648
4649option splice-response
4650no option splice-response
4651 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 yes | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments : none
4655
4656 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004657 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004658 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4659 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4660 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4661 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4662
4663 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4664
4665 Example :
4666 option splice-response
4667
4668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4670
4671 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4672 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4673
4674
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004675option srvtcpka
4676no option srvtcpka
4677 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4679 yes | no | yes | yes
4680 Arguments : none
4681
4682 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4683 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4684 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4685 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4686
4687 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4688 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4689 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4690 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4691
4692 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4693 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4694 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4695 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4696 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4697
4698 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4699
4700 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4701 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4702 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4703
4704 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4705 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4706
4707 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4708
4709
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004710option ssl-hello-chk
4711 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4713 yes | no | yes | yes
4714 Arguments : none
4715
4716 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4717 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4718 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4719 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4720 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4721 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4722 hello message.
4723
4724 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4725 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4726 messages, which is appreciable.
4727
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004728 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4729 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4730 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004731
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004732 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4733
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004734
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004735option tcp-check
4736 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 yes | no | yes | yes
4739
4740 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4741 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4742
4743 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4744 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4745 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4746
4747 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4748 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4749 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4750 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4751 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4752 only.
4753
4754 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4755 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4756 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4757 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4758 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4759
4760 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4761 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4762 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4763 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4764 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4765 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4766 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4767 the respective protocols.
4768 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4769 analysed.
4770
4771 Examples :
4772 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4773 option tcp-check
4774 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4775
4776 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4777 option tcp-check
4778 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4779
4780 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4781 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4782 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4783 option tcp-check
4784 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4785 tcp-check expect +PONG
4786 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4787 tcp-check expect string role:master
4788 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4789 tcp-check expect string +OK
4790
4791 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4792 (send many headers before analyzing)
4793 option tcp-check
4794 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4795 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4796 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4797 tcp-check send \r\n
4798 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4799
4800
4801 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4802
4803
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004804option tcp-smart-accept
4805no option tcp-smart-accept
4806 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | yes | yes | no
4809 Arguments : none
4810
4811 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4812 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4813 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4814 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4815 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4816 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4817
4818 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4819 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4820 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4821 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4822
4823 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4824 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4825 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4826 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4827
4828 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4829 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4830 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4831
4832 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4833 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4834 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4835
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004836 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4837
4838
4839option tcp-smart-connect
4840no option tcp-smart-connect
4841 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 yes | no | yes | yes
4844 Arguments : none
4845
4846 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4847 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4848 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4849 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4850 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4851
4852 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4853 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4854 complex.
4855
4856 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4857 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4858 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4859
4860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4862
4863 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4864
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004865
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004866option tcpka
4867 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4869 yes | yes | yes | yes
4870 Arguments : none
4871
4872 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4873 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4874 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4875 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4876
4877 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4878 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4879 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4880 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4881
4882 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4883 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4884 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4885 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4886 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4887
4888 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4889
4890 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4891 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4892 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4893 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4894 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4895 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4896 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4897 backends.
4898
4899 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4900
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004901
4902option tcplog
4903 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | yes
4906 Arguments : none
4907
4908 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4909 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4910 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4911 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4912 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4913 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4914 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4915 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4916
4917 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004919 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004920
4921
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004922option transparent
4923no option transparent
4924 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004926 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004927 Arguments : none
4928
4929 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4930 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4931 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4932 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4933 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4934 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4935 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4936 appropriate server.
4937
4938 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4939 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4940
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004941 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004942 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004943
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004944
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004945persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004946persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004947 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4949 yes | no | yes | yes
4950 Arguments :
4951 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004952 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4953 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004954
4955 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4956 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4957 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4958 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4959 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4960 forwarded to this server.
4961
4962 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4963 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4964 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004965 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004966 a single "listen" section.
4967
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004968 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4969 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4970 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4971
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004972 Example :
4973 listen tse-farm
4974 bind :3389
4975 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4976 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4977 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4978 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4979 persist rdp-cookie
4980 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004981 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004982 balance rdp-cookie
4983 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4984 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4985
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004986 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4987 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004988
4989
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004990rate-limit sessions <rate>
4991 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4993 yes | yes | yes | no
4994 Arguments :
4995 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4996 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4997
4998 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4999 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5000 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5001 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5002 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5003 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5004
5005 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5006 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5007 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5008 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5009
5010 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5011 listen smtp
5012 mode tcp
5013 bind :25
5014 rate-limit sessions 10
5015 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5016
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005017 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5018 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5019 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005020
5021 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5022
5023
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005024redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5025redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5026redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005027 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 no | yes | yes | yes
5030
5031 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005032 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005033
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005034 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005035 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005036 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5037 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5038 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005039
5040 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5041 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5042 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5043 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5044 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005045 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5046 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5047 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5048 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005049
5050 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5051 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5052 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5053 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5054 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5055 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5056 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5057 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005058 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5059 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5060 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005061
5062 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005063 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5064 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5065 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5066 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5067 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5068 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5069 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5070 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005071
5072 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5073 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5074
5075 - "drop-query"
5076 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5077 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5078 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5079 with a location-type redirect.
5080
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005081 - "append-slash"
5082 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5083 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5084 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5085 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5086
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005087 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5088 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5089 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5090 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5091 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5092 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5093 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5094
5095 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5096 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5097 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5098 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5099 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5100 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5101 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005102
5103 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5104 acl clear dst_port 80
5105 acl secure dst_port 8080
5106 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005107 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005108 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005109 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5110
5111 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005112 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5113 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5114 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005115 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005116
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005117 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5118 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5119 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5120
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005121 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005122 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005123
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005124 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5125 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5126 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005128 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005129
5130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005131redisp (deprecated)
5132redispatch (deprecated)
5133 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005136 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005137
5138 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5139 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5140 be able to access the service anymore.
5141
5142 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5143 redistribute them to a working server.
5144
5145 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5146 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5147 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005149 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5150 "option redispatch" instead.
5151
5152 See also : "option redispatch"
5153
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005154
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005155reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005156 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5158 no | yes | yes | yes
5159 Arguments :
5160 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5161 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005162 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005163
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005164 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5165 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5166
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005167 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5168 the last header of an HTTP request.
5169
5170 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5171 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5172 responses.
5173
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005174 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5175 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5176 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5177
5178 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5179 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005180
5181
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005182reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5183reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005184 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5186 no | yes | yes | yes
5187 Arguments :
5188 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5189 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5190 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5191 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5192 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5193 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5194 ignores case.
5195
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005196 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5197 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5198
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005199 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5200 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5201 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5202 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005203 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005204
5205 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5206 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5207
5208 Example :
5209 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5210 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5211 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5212
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005213 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5214 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005215
5216
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005217reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5218reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005219 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 no | yes | yes | yes
5222 Arguments :
5223 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5224 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5225 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5226 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5227 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5228 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5229
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005230 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5231 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5232
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005233 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5234 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5235 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5236 next servers.
5237
5238 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5239 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5240 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5241
5242 Example :
5243 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5244 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5245 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5246
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005247 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5248 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005249
5250
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005251reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5252reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005253 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5255 no | yes | yes | yes
5256 Arguments :
5257 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5258 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5259 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5260 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5261 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5262 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5263 case.
5264
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005265 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5266 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5267
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005268 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5269 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5270 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5271 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005272 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005273
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005274 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005275 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005276 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005277
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005278 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5279 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5280
5281 Example :
5282 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5283 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5284 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5285
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005286 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5287 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005288
5289
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005290reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5291reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005292 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5294 no | yes | yes | yes
5295 Arguments :
5296 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5297 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5298 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5299 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5300 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5301 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5302 case.
5303
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005304 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5305 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5306
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005307 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5308 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5309 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5310 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5311
5312 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5313 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5314
5315 Example :
5316 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5317 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5318 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5319 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005321 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5322 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005323
5324
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005325reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5326reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005327 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 no | yes | yes | yes
5330 Arguments :
5331 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5332 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5333 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5334 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5335 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5336 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5337
5338 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5339 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5340 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5341 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005342 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005344 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5345 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5346
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005347 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5348 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5349 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5350
5351 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5352 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5353 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5354 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5355 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5356
5357 Example :
5358 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005359 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005360 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5361 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5362
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005363 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5364 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005365
5366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005367reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5368reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005369 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 no | yes | yes | yes
5372 Arguments :
5373 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5374 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5375 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5376 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5377 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5378 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5379 ignores case.
5380
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005381 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5382 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5383
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005384 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5385 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005386 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5387 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5388 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005389 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5390 not set.
5391
5392 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5393 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5394 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5395 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5396 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005398 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005399 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5400 # block all others.
5401 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5402 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5403
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005404 # block bad guys
5405 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5406 reqitarpit . if badguys
5407
5408 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5409 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005410
5411
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005412retries <value>
5413 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5414 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 yes | no | yes | yes
5416 Arguments :
5417 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5418 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5419 default value is 3.
5420
5421 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5422 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5423 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5424
5425 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5426 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5427
5428 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5429 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5430
5431 See also : "option redispatch"
5432
5433
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005434rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005435 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 no | yes | yes | yes
5438 Arguments :
5439 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5440 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005441 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005442
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005443 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5444 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5445
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005446 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5447 the last header of an HTTP response.
5448
5449 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5450 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5451 responses.
5452
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005453 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5454 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005455
5456
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005457rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5458rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005459 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 no | yes | yes | yes
5462 Arguments :
5463 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5464 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5465 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5466 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5467 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5468 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5469 ignores case.
5470
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005471 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5472 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5473
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005474 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5475 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005476 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005477 client.
5478
5479 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5480 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5481 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5482
5483 Example :
5484 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005485 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005487 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5488 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005489
5490
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005491rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5492rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005493 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 no | yes | yes | yes
5496 Arguments :
5497 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5498 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5499 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5500 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5501 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5502 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5503 ignores case.
5504
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005505 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5506 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5507
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005508 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5509 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5510 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5511 case-sensitive.
5512
5513 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005514 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5515 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5516 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005517
5518 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5519 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5520
5521 Example :
5522 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5523 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5524
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005525 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5526 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005527
5528
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005529rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5530rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005531 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5533 no | yes | yes | yes
5534 Arguments :
5535 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5536 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5537 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5538 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5539 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5540 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5541 ignores case.
5542
5543 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5544 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5545 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5546 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005547 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005548
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005549 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5550 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5551
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005552 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5553 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5554 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5555
5556 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5557 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5558 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5559 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5560 are not case-sensitive.
5561
5562 Example :
5563 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5564 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5565
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005566 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5567 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005568
5569
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005570server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005571 Declare a server in a backend
5572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5573 no | no | yes | yes
5574 Arguments :
5575 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005576 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005577 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005578
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005579 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5580 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5581 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5582 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005583 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5584 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5585 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5586 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5587 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005588 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5589 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5590 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5591 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5592 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5593 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5594 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005595 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5596 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5597 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5598 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005599
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005600 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005601 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5602 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5603 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5604 adding this value to the client's port.
5605
5606 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5607 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005608 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005609
5610 Examples :
5611 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5612 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005613 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005614 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5615 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5616 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005617
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005618 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5619 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005620
5621
5622source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005623source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005624source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005625 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | no | yes | yes
5628 Arguments :
5629 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5630 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005631
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005632 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005633 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5634 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5635 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5636 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5637 supported prefixes are :
5638 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5639 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5640 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005641 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5642 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5643 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5644 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005645
5646 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5647 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005648 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5649 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5650 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005651
5652 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5653 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5654 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5655 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5656 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5657 <addr>.
5658
5659 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5660 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5661 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5662 port.
5663
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005664 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5665 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5666 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5667 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005668 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005669 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5670 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5671 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5672 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5673 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5674 HTTP header.
5675
5676 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5677 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005678 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005679 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5680 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5681 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5682 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5683 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5684 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5685 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5686
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005687 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5688 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5689 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5690 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5691 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5692 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5693
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005694 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5695 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5696 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5697 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5698
5699 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5700 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5701 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5702 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5703 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5704 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5705
5706 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5707 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5708 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5709 there are two methods :
5710
5711 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5712 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5713 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5714 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5715 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5716 of the client ranges may be used.
5717
5718 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5719 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5720 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5721 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5722 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5723 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5724 same session.
5725
5726 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5727 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5728 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5729 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5730 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5731 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5732
5733 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5734 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5735 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005736 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005737
5738 Examples :
5739 backend private
5740 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5741 source 192.168.1.200
5742
5743 backend transparent_ssl1
5744 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5745 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5746
5747 backend transparent_ssl2
5748 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5749 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5750 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5751
5752 backend transparent_ssl3
5753 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5754 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5755 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5756
5757 backend transparent_smtp
5758 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5759 # with Tproxy version 4.
5760 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5761
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005762 backend transparent_http
5763 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5764 # proxy.
5765 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005767 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005768 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005770
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005771srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5772 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | no | yes | yes
5775 Arguments :
5776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5778 as explained at the top of this document.
5779
5780 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5781 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5782 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5783 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5784 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5785 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5786 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5787
5788 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5789 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5790 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5791 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5792 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005793 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005794 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005795 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005796
5797 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5798 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5799 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5800 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5801 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5802 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5803
5804 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5805 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5806
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005807 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5808 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005809
5810
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005811stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5812 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 no | no | yes | yes
5815
5816 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5817 matched.
5818
5819 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5820 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5821
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005822 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5823 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5824 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5825
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005826 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5827 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5828 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5829 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005830
5831 Example :
5832 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5833 backend stats_localhost
5834 stats enable
5835 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5836
5837 Example :
5838 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5839 backend stats_auth
5840 stats enable
5841 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5842 stats admin if TRUE
5843
5844 Example :
5845 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5846 userlist stats-auth
5847 group admin users admin
5848 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5849 group readonly users haproxy
5850 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5851
5852 backend stats_auth
5853 stats enable
5854 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5855 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5856 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5857 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5858
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005859 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5860 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5861 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005862
5863
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005864stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5865 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 yes | no | yes | yes
5868 Arguments :
5869 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5870
5871 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5872
5873 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5874 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5875 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5876 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5877 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5878 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5879
5880 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5881 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5882 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005883 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005884
5885 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5886 report using "stats scope".
5887
5888 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5889 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5890 unobvious parameters.
5891
5892 Example :
5893 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5894 backend public_www
5895 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5896 stats enable
5897 stats hide-version
5898 stats scope .
5899 stats uri /admin?stats
5900 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5901 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5902 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5903
5904 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5905 backend private_monitoring
5906 stats enable
5907 stats uri /admin?stats
5908 stats refresh 5s
5909
5910 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5911
5912
5913stats enable
5914 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | no | yes | yes
5917 Arguments : none
5918
5919 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5920 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5921 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5922 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5923 - stats auth : no authentication
5924 - stats scope : no restriction
5925
5926 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5927 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5928 unobvious parameters.
5929
5930 Example :
5931 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5932 backend public_www
5933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5934 stats enable
5935 stats hide-version
5936 stats scope .
5937 stats uri /admin?stats
5938 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5939 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5940 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5941
5942 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5943 backend private_monitoring
5944 stats enable
5945 stats uri /admin?stats
5946 stats refresh 5s
5947
5948 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5949
5950
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005951stats hide-version
5952 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5954 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005955 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005957 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5958 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5959 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5960 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5961 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5962 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005964 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5965 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5966 unobvious parameters.
5967
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005968 Example :
5969 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5970 backend public_www
5971 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005972 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005973 stats hide-version
5974 stats scope .
5975 stats uri /admin?stats
5976 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5977 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5978 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005979
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005980 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5981 backend private_monitoring
5982 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005983 stats uri /admin?stats
5984 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005986 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005987
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005988
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005989stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5990 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5991 Access control for statistics
5992
5993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 no | no | yes | yes
5995
5996 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5997 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5998 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5999 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6000 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6001 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6002
6003 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6004 instance.
6005
6006 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6007 about ACL usage.
6008
6009
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006010stats realm <realm>
6011 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | no | yes | yes
6014 Arguments :
6015 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6016 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6017 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6018
6019 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6020 using a backslash ('\').
6021
6022 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6023 only related to authentication.
6024
6025 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6026 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6027 unobvious parameters.
6028
6029 Example :
6030 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6031 backend public_www
6032 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6033 stats enable
6034 stats hide-version
6035 stats scope .
6036 stats uri /admin?stats
6037 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6038 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6039 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6040
6041 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6042 backend private_monitoring
6043 stats enable
6044 stats uri /admin?stats
6045 stats refresh 5s
6046
6047 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6048
6049
6050stats refresh <delay>
6051 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6053 yes | no | yes | yes
6054 Arguments :
6055 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6056 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6057 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6058 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6059 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6060 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6061
6062 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6063 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6064 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6065 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6066
6067 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6068 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6069 unobvious parameters.
6070
6071 Example :
6072 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6073 backend public_www
6074 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6075 stats enable
6076 stats hide-version
6077 stats scope .
6078 stats uri /admin?stats
6079 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6080 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6081 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6082
6083 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6084 backend private_monitoring
6085 stats enable
6086 stats uri /admin?stats
6087 stats refresh 5s
6088
6089 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6090
6091
6092stats scope { <name> | "." }
6093 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | no | yes | yes
6096 Arguments :
6097 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6098 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6099 section in which the statement appears.
6100
6101 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6102 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6103 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6104 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6105 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6106 exists.
6107
6108 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6109 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6110 unobvious parameters.
6111
6112 Example :
6113 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6114 backend public_www
6115 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6116 stats enable
6117 stats hide-version
6118 stats scope .
6119 stats uri /admin?stats
6120 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6121 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6122 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6123
6124 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6125 backend private_monitoring
6126 stats enable
6127 stats uri /admin?stats
6128 stats refresh 5s
6129
6130 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6131
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006132
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006133stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006134 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6136 yes | no | yes | yes
6137
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006138 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006139 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6140
6141 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6142 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6143
6144 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6145 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006146 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006147
6148 Example :
6149 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6150 backend private_monitoring
6151 stats enable
6152 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6153 stats uri /admin?stats
6154 stats refresh 5s
6155
6156 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6157 global section.
6158
6159
6160stats show-legends
6161 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6162 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6163 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6164 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6165 - IP (socket, server)
6166 - cookie (backend, server)
6167
6168 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6169 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006170 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006171
6172 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6173
6174
6175stats show-node [ <name> ]
6176 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6178 yes | no | yes | yes
6179 Arguments:
6180 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6181 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6182
6183 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6184 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006185 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006186
6187 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6188 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6189 unobvious parameters.
6190
6191 Example:
6192 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6193 backend private_monitoring
6194 stats enable
6195 stats show-node Europe-1
6196 stats uri /admin?stats
6197 stats refresh 5s
6198
6199 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6200 section.
6201
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006202
6203stats uri <prefix>
6204 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6206 yes | no | yes | yes
6207 Arguments :
6208 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6209 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6210 query string.
6211
6212 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6213 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6214 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6215 possible to reach it in the application.
6216
6217 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006218 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006219 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6220 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6221 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6222 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6223
6224 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6225 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6226 an address or a port to statistics only.
6227
6228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6230 unobvious parameters.
6231
6232 Example :
6233 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6234 backend public_www
6235 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6236 stats enable
6237 stats hide-version
6238 stats scope .
6239 stats uri /admin?stats
6240 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6241 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6242 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6243
6244 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6245 backend private_monitoring
6246 stats enable
6247 stats uri /admin?stats
6248 stats refresh 5s
6249
6250 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6251
6252
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006253stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6254 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006256 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006257
6258 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006259 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006260 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6261 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6262 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6263
6264 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6265 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6266 the "stick-table" statement.
6267
6268 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6269 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6270 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6271 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6272 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6273
6274 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6275 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6276 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6277 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6278 transformation rules.
6279
6280 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6281 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6282 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6283 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6284 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6285 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6286 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6287
6288 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6289 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6290 ACL based conditions.
6291
6292 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6293 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6294 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6295 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6296
6297 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6298 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6299 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6300 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6301
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006302 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6303 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6304 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6305
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006306 Example :
6307 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6308 # last 30 minutes
6309 backend pop
6310 mode tcp
6311 balance roundrobin
6312 stick store-request src
6313 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6314 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6315 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6316
6317 backend smtp
6318 mode tcp
6319 balance roundrobin
6320 stick match src table pop
6321 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6322 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6323
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006324 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6325 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006326
6327
6328stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6329 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6331 no | no | yes | yes
6332
6333 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6334 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6335 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6336 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6337
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006338 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6339 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6340 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006342 Examples :
6343 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006344 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006345
6346 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6347 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6348 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6349
6350
6351 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6352 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6353 backend http
6354 mode http
6355 balance roundrobin
6356 stick on src table https
6357 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6358 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6359 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6360
6361 backend https
6362 mode tcp
6363 balance roundrobin
6364 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6365 stick on src
6366 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6367 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6368
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006369 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006370
6371
6372stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6373 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 no | no | yes | yes
6376
6377 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006378 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006379 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6380 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6381 server is selected.
6382
6383 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6384 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6385 the "stick-table" statement.
6386
6387 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6388 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6389 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6390 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6391 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6392 address.
6393
6394 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6395 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6396 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6397 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6398 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6399 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6400 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6401 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6402 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6403 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6404
6405 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6406 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6407 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6408 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6409 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6410 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6411 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6412
6413 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6414 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6415 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6416 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6417
6418 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6419 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6420 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6421 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6422 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6423 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006424 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6425 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6426 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6427 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6428 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6429 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006430
6431 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6432 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6433 the request.
6434
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006435 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6436 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6437 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6438
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006439 Example :
6440 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6441 # last 30 minutes
6442 backend pop
6443 mode tcp
6444 balance roundrobin
6445 stick store-request src
6446 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6447 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6448 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6449
6450 backend smtp
6451 mode tcp
6452 balance roundrobin
6453 stick match src table pop
6454 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6455 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6456
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006457 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6458 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006459
6460
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006461stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006462 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6463 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006464 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006466 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006467
6468 Arguments :
6469 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6470 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6471 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6472 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6473
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006474 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6475 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6476 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6477 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6478
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006479 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6480 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6481 instance.
6482
6483 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6484 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6485 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6486 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6487 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6488 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006489 to 32 characters.
6490
6491 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6492 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6493 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6494 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6495 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6496 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006497
6498 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006499 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6500 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006501 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6502 increase.
6503
6504 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006505 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6506 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6507 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006508
6509 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6510 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6511 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6512 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6513 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6514 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6515 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6516 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6517 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6518 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6519 parameter (see below).
6520
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006521 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6522 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6523 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6524 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6525 soft restart.
6526
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006527 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6528
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006529 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6530 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6531 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6532 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6533 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006534 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006535 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6536 if not expiration delay is specified.
6537
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006538 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6539 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6540 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6541 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006542 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6543 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6544 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6545 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6546 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6547 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6548 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6549 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6550 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6551 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6552 types and their arguments.
6553
6554 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6555 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6556 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6557 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6558
6559 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6560 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6561 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6562 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6563
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006564 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6565 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6566 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6567 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6568 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6569 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6570
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006571 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6572 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6573 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6574 they were received.
6575
6576 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6577 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6578 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6579 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6580 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6581
6582 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6583 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6584 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6585 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6586 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6587
6588 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6589 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6590 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6591
6592 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6593 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6594 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6595 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6596 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6597
6598 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6599 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6600 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6601 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6602 the client side.
6603
6604 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6605 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6606 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6607 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6608 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6609 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6610 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6611
6612 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6613 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6614 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6615 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6616 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6617 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6618 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6619
6620 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6621 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6622 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6623 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6624 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6625 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6626
6627 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6628 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6629 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6630 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6631
6632 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6633 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6634 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6635 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6636 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6637 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6638 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6639 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6640 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6641 recommended for better fairness.
6642
6643 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6644 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6645 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6646 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6647
6648 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6649 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6650 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6651 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6652 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6653 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6654 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6655 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6656 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6657 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006658
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006659 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6660 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006661 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6662 reference it.
6663
6664 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6665 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6666 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6667 as an exclusive stickiness.
6668
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006669 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6670 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6671 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6672 something that can be ignored.
6673
6674 Example:
6675 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6676 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6677 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6678 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6679
6680 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006681 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006682
6683
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006684stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6685 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 no | no | yes | yes
6688
6689 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006690 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006691 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6692 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6693 server is selected.
6694
6695 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6696 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6697 the "stick-table" statement.
6698
6699 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6700 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6701 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6702 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6703
6704 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6705 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6706 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6707 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6708 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6709 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006710 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006711 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6712 rules.
6713
6714 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6715 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6716 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6717 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6718 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6719 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6720 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6721
6722 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6723 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6724 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6725 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6726
6727 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6728 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6729 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6730 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6731 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6732 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006733 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6734 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6735 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6736 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6737 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6738 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6739 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6740 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6741 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006742
6743 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6744
6745 Example :
6746 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6747 backend https
6748 mode tcp
6749 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006750 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006751 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006752
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006753 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6754 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6755
6756 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6757 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6758 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6759
6760 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6761 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006762
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006763 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6764 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6765 # at offset 44.
6766
6767 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6768 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6769
6770 # Learn on response if server hello.
6771 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006772
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006773 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6774 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6775
6776 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6777 extraction.
6778
6779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006780tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6781 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6783 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006784 Arguments :
6785 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006786 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6787 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006788
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006789 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006790
6791 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6792 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006793 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6794 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6795 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6796 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6797 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6798 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006800 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6801 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6802 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6803 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006804
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006805 Three types of actions are supported :
6806 - accept :
6807 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6808 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6809 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006811 - reject :
6812 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6813 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6814 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6815 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6816 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6817 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6818 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6819 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6820 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6821 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6822 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6823 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006824
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006825 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6826 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6827 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6828 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6829 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6830 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6831 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6832 hosts.
6833
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006834 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006835 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6836 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6837 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006838 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6839 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006840 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006841 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6842 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6843 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6844 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6845 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006846
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006847 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006848 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006849 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006850 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6851 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6852 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6853 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006855 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6856 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6857 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6858 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006860 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6861 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6862 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6863 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6864 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006865 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6866 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6867 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6868 layer7 information is extracted.
6869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006870 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6871 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6872 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6873 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6874 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006876 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6877 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6878 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006880 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6881 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6882 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006883
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006884 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006885 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006886 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006888 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6889 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6890 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006892 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006893 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6894 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006895
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006896 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6897
6898 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6899
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006900 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006902 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006903
6904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006905tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6906 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006908 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006909 Arguments :
6910 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006911 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6912 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006913 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006914
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006915 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006917 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6918 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6919 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6920 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6921 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006923 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6924 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6925 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6926 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01006927 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
6928 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
6929 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
6930 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
6931 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
6932 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
6933 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditionned by an
6934 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006936 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6937 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6938 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6939 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006940
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006941 Three types of actions are supported :
6942 - accept :
6943 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006944 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006946 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6947 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006948
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01006949 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
6950 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
6951 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
6952 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
6953 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
6954 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006956 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006957 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6958 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006960 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006961 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6962 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6963 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6964 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01006965 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
6966 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
6967 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006968
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006969 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6970 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6971 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6972 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6973
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006974 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006975 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6976 # and reject everything else.
6977 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6978 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006979 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006980 tcp-request content reject
6981
6982 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006983 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6984 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6985 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006986 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006987
6988 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6989 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6990 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006991 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006992 tcp-request content reject
6993
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006994 Example:
6995 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6996 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006997 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006998
6999 Example:
7000 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7001 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007002 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007004 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7005 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7006
7007 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007008 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007009 # protecting all our sites
7010 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007011 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7012 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007013 ...
7014 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7015
7016 backend http_dynamic
7017 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007018 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007019 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007020 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7021 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7022 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007023 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007025 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007026
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007027 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007028
7029
7030tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7031 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007033 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007034 Arguments :
7035 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7036 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7037 as explained at the top of this document.
7038
7039 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7040 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7041 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7042 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7043 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7044
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007045 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7046 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7047 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7048 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7049
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007050 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7051 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007052 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007053 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007054 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7055 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7056 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7057 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007058
7059 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7060 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7061 it pass through unaffected.
7062
7063 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7064 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7065 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007066 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007067 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7068 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007069 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7070 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7071 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007072
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007073 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007074 "timeout client".
7075
7076
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007077tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7078 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7080 no | no | yes | yes
7081 Arguments :
7082 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007083 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007084
7085 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7086
7087 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7088 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7089 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007090 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7091 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007092
7093 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7094
7095 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7096 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7097 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7098 inserted.
7099
7100 Two types of actions are supported :
7101 - accept :
7102 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7103 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7104 the rules evaluation.
7105
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007106 - close :
7107 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7108 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7109 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7110 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7111 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7112 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7113 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7114 protocols.
7115
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007116 - reject :
7117 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7118 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007119 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007120
7121 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7122 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7123 for changing the default action to a reject.
7124
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007125 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7126 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7127 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7128 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007129 period.
7130
7131 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7132
7133 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7134
7135
7136tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7137 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7139 no | no | yes | yes
7140 Arguments :
7141 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7142 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7143 as explained at the top of this document.
7144
7145 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7146
7147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007148timeout check <timeout>
7149 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7150 established.
7151
7152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 yes | no | yes | yes
7154 Arguments:
7155 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7156 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7157 as explained at the top of this document.
7158
7159 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7160 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7161 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7162 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007163 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7164 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7165 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007166
7167 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7168 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7169
7170 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7171 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007172 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007173
7174 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7175 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7176 forget about it.
7177
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007178 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7179 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007180
7181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007182timeout client <timeout>
7183timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7184 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7186 yes | yes | yes | no
7187 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007188 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007189 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7190 as explained at the top of this document.
7191
7192 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7193 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7194 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7195 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7196 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7197 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7198 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7199 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007200 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007201 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007202 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7203 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7204 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007205
7206 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7207 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7208 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7209 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7210 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7211 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7212
7213 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7214 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7215 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7216
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007217 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007218
7219
7220timeout connect <timeout>
7221timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7222 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 yes | no | yes | yes
7225 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007226 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007227 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7228 as explained at the top of this document.
7229
7230 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007231 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007232 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007233 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007234 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7235 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007236
7237 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7238 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7239 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7240 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7241 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7242 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7243
7244 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7245 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7246 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7247
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007248 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7249 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007250
7251
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007252timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7253 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7255 yes | yes | yes | yes
7256 Arguments :
7257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7259 as explained at the top of this document.
7260
7261 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7262 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7263 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7264 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7265 once the request has started to present itself.
7266
7267 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7268 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7269 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7270 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7271 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7272
7273 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7274 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7275 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7276 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7277
7278 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7279 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7280 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7281 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7282 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007283 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007284
7285 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7286 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7287 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7288 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7289
7290 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7291
7292
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007293timeout http-request <timeout>
7294 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007296 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007297 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007298 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007299 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7300 as explained at the top of this document.
7301
7302 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7303 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7304 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7305 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7306 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7307 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7308 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7309 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7310
7311 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7312 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007313 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7314 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007315
7316 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7317 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7318 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7319 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7320 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7321
7322 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007323 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7324 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7325 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007326
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007327 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007328
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007329
7330timeout queue <timeout>
7331 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7333 yes | no | yes | yes
7334 Arguments :
7335 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7336 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7337 as explained at the top of this document.
7338
7339 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7340 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7341 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7342 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7343 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7344
7345 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7346 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7347 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7348 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7349
7350 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7351
7352
7353timeout server <timeout>
7354timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7355 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | no | yes | yes
7358 Arguments :
7359 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7360 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7361 as explained at the top of this document.
7362
7363 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7364 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7365 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7366 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7367 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7368 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7369 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7370
7371 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7372 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7373 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7374 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7375 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007376 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007377 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007378 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7379 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7380 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7381 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007382
7383 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7384 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7385 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7386 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7387 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7388 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7389
7390 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7391 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7392 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7393
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007394 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007395
7396
7397timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007398 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 yes | yes | yes | yes
7401 Arguments :
7402 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7403 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7404 as explained at the top of this document.
7405
7406 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7407 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7408 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7409
7410 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7411 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7412 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7413 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007414 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007415
7416 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7417
7418
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007419timeout tunnel <timeout>
7420 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7422 yes | no | yes | yes
7423 Arguments :
7424 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7425 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7426 as explained at the top of this document.
7427
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007428 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007429 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7430 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7431 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7432 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7433 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7434 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7435 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7436 specified.
7437
7438 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7439 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7440 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7441 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7442 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7443
7444 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7445 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7446 forget about it.
7447
7448 Example :
7449 defaults http
7450 option http-server-close
7451 timeout connect 5s
7452 timeout client 30s
7453 timeout client 30s
7454 timeout server 30s
7455 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7456
7457 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7458
7459
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007460transparent (deprecated)
7461 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007463 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007464 Arguments : none
7465
7466 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7467 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7468 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7469 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7470 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7471 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7472 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7473 appropriate server.
7474
7475 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7476
7477 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7478 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7479
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007480 See also: "option transparent"
7481
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007482unique-id-format <string>
7483 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7485 yes | yes | yes | no
7486 Arguments :
7487 <string> is a log-format string.
7488
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007489 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7490 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7491 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7492 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007493
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007494 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7495 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7496 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7497 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7498 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7499 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7500 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7501 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007502
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007503 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7504 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007505
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007506 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007507
7508 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7509
7510 will generate:
7511
7512 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7513
7514 See also: "unique-id-header"
7515
7516unique-id-header <name>
7517 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7519 yes | yes | yes | no
7520 Arguments :
7521 <name> is the name of the header.
7522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007523 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7524 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007525
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007526 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007527
7528 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7529 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7530
7531 will generate:
7532
7533 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7534
7535 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007536
7537use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7538use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007539 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 no | yes | yes | no
7542 Arguments :
7543 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007545 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007546
7547 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7548 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7549 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007550 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7551 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7552 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7553 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007554
7555 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7556 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7557 assign the backend.
7558
7559 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7560 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7561 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7562 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7563 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7564 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7565
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007566 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007567 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007568 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7569 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7570 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7571
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007572 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007573
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007574
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007575use-server <server> if <condition>
7576use-server <server> unless <condition>
7577 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7579 no | no | yes | yes
7580 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007581 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007582
7583 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7584
7585 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7586 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7587 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7588
7589 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7590 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7591 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7592 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7593 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7594 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7595 matches will assign the server.
7596
7597 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7598 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7599 with the next rules until one matches.
7600
7601 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7602 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7603 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7604 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7605
7606 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7607 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7608 stripped.
7609
7610 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7611 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7612 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7613 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7614
7615 Example :
7616 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7617 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7618 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7619 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7620 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7621 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7622 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7623 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7624 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7625
7626 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7627
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007628
76295. Bind and Server options
7630--------------------------
7631
7632The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7633depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7634settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7635written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7636described in this section.
7637
7638
76395.1. Bind options
7640-----------------
7641
7642The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7643as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7644no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7645parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7646while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7647provided immediately after the setting name.
7648
7649The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7650
7651accept-proxy
7652 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7653 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7654 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7655 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7656 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7657 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7658 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7659 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7660 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007661 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7662 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007663
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007664alpn <protocols>
7665 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7666 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7667 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7668 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7669 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7670 initial NPN extension.
7671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007672backlog <backlog>
7673 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7674 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7675
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007676ecdhe <named curve>
7677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007678 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7679 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007680
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007681ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7683 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7684 client's certificate.
7685
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007686ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7688 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7689 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7690 error is ignored.
7691
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007692ciphers <ciphers>
7693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7694 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7695 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7696 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7697 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7698
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007699crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007700 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7701 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7702 to verify client's certificate.
7703
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007704crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7706 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7707 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7708 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7709 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7710 file.
7711
7712 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7713 are loaded.
7714
7715 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7716 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7717 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7718 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7719 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7720 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7721 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7722 www.sub.example.org).
7723
7724 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7725 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7726 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7727 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7728 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7729
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007730 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007731
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007732 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7733 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7734 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7735 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7736 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7737 clients).
7738
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007739crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7741 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7742 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7743 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007744
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007745crt-list <file>
7746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007747 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7748 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007749
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007750 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007751
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007752 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7753 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7754 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7755 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7756 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7757 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7758 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7759 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007760
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007761defer-accept
7762 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7763 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7764 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7765 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7766 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7767 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7768 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7769 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7770 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7771 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7772 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7773
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007774force-sslv3
7775 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7776 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7777 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7778
7779force-tlsv10
7780 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7781 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7782
7783force-tlsv11
7784 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7785 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7786
7787force-tlsv12
7788 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7789 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007791gid <gid>
7792 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7793 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7794 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7795 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7796 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7797
7798group <group>
7799 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7800 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7801 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7802 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7803 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7804
7805id <id>
7806 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7807 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7808 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7809 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7810
7811interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007812 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7813 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7814 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7815 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7816 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7817 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7818 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007819
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007820level <level>
7821 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7822 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7823 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7824 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7825 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7826 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7827 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7828 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7829 counters).
7830 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7831 all counters).
7832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007833maxconn <maxconn>
7834 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7835 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7836 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7837 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7838 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7839 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7840 eat all memory.
7841
7842mode <mode>
7843 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7844 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7845 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7846 UNIX sockets.
7847
7848mss <maxseg>
7849 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7850 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7851 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7852 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7853 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7854 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7855 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7856 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7857 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7858 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7859 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7860
7861name <name>
7862 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7863 page.
7864
7865nice <nice>
7866 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7867 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7868 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7869 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7870 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7871 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7872 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7873 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7874 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7875 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7876 one for an RDP socket.
7877
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007878no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7880 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7881 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007882 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7883 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007884
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007885no-tls-tickets
7886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7887 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7888 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7889 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7890
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007891no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007893 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7894 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7895 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7896 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007897
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007898no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007900 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7901 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7902 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7903 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007904
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007905no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007907 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7908 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7909 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7910 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007911
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007912npn <protocols>
7913 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7914 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7915 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7916 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007917 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7918 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007919
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007920ssl
7921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7922 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7923 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7924 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7925 to deciphered contents.
7926
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007927strict-sni
7928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7929 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7930 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7931 See the "crt" option for more information.
7932
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007933tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007934 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007935 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7936 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7937 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7938 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7939 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7940 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7941 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007942 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7943 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7944 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007945
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007946transparent
7947 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7948 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7949 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7950 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7951 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7952 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7953 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7954 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7955 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7956 so check for support with your vendor.
7957
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007958v4v6
7959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7960 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7961 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7962 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7963 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7964
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007965v6only
7966 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7967 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7968 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007969 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7970 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007971
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007972uid <uid>
7973 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7974 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7975 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7976 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7977 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7978
7979user <user>
7980 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7981 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7982 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7983 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7984 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7985
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007986verify [none|optional|required]
7987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7988 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7989 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7990 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7991 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007992 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7993 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7994 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7995 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020079975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007998------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008000The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8001which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8002arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8003settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8004after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8005Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8006address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008008 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008009 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008011The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008012
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008013addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008014 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8015 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8016 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8017 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8018 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008020 Supported in default-server: No
8021
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008022agent-check
8023 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8024 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8025 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8026 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8027
8028 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8029 e.g. "75%"
8030
8031 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8032 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8033
8034 * The string "drain".
8035
8036 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8037 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8038 persistence.
8039
8040 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8041
8042 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8043
8044 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8045
8046 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8047
8048 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8049
8050 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8051
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008052 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8053 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8054 parameter.
8055
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008056 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8057 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8058
8059 Supported in default-server: No
8060
8061agent-inter <delay>
8062 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8063 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8064
8065 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8066 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8067 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8068 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8069 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8070 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8071 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8072 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8073 of backends use the same servers.
8074
8075 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8076
8077 Supported in default-server: Yes
8078
8079agent-port <port>
8080 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8081
8082 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8083
8084 Supported in default-server: Yes
8085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008086backup
8087 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8088 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8089 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8090 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8091 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8092 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008094 Supported in default-server: No
8095
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008096ca-file <cafile>
8097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8098 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8099 server's certificate.
8100
8101 Supported in default-server: No
8102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008103check
8104 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008105 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8106 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8107 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8108 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8109 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8110 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8111 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008112 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8113 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8114 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008116 Supported in default-server: No
8117
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008118check-send-proxy
8119 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8120 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8121 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8122 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8123 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8124 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8125 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8126
8127 Supported in default-server: No
8128
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008129check-ssl
8130 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8131 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8132 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8133 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8134 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8135 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8136 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8137 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8138 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8139
8140 Supported in default-server: No
8141
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008142ciphers <ciphers>
8143 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8144 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8145 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8146 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8147 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8148 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8149 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8150 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8151
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008152 Supported in default-server: No
8153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008154cookie <value>
8155 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8156 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8157 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8158 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8159 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8160 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8161 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008163 Supported in default-server: No
8164
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008165crl-file <crlfile>
8166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8167 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8168 to verify server's certificate.
8169
8170 Supported in default-server: No
8171
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008172crt <cert>
8173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8174 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8175 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8176 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8177 certificate request.
8178
8179 Supported in default-server: No
8180
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008181disabled
8182 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8183 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8184 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8185 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8186 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8187
8188 Supported in default-server: No
8189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008190error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008191 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8192 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8193 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008195 Supported in default-server: Yes
8196
8197 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008199fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008200 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8201 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8202 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008204 Supported in default-server: Yes
8205
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008206force-sslv3
8207 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8208 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8209 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8210
8211 Supported in default-server: No
8212
8213force-tlsv10
8214 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8215 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8216
8217 Supported in default-server: No
8218
8219force-tlsv11
8220 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8221 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8222
8223 Supported in default-server: No
8224
8225force-tlsv12
8226 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8227 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8228
8229 Supported in default-server: No
8230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008231id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008232 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8233 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8234 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008236 Supported in default-server: No
8237
8238inter <delay>
8239fastinter <delay>
8240downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008241 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8242 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8243 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8244 between checks depending on the server state :
8245
8246 Server state | Interval used
8247 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8248 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8249 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8250 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8251 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8252 or yet unchecked. |
8253 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8254 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8255 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008257 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8258 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8259 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8260 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008261 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8262 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8263 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8264 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8265 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008267 Supported in default-server: Yes
8268
8269maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008270 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8271 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8272 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8273 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8274 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8275 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8276 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8277 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008279 Supported in default-server: Yes
8280
8281maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008282 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8283 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8284 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8285 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8286 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8287 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8288 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008290 Supported in default-server: Yes
8291
8292minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008293 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8294 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8295 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8296 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8297 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8298 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008299 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008300 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008302 Supported in default-server: Yes
8303
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008304no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008305 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8306 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008307 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008308
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008309 Supported in default-server: No
8310
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008311no-tls-tickets
8312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8313 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8314 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8315 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8316
8317 Supported in default-server: No
8318
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008319no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008320 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008321 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8322 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008323 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8324 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008325
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008326 Supported in default-server: No
8327
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008328no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008329 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008330 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8331 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008332 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8333 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008334
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008335 Supported in default-server: No
8336
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008337no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008338 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008339 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8340 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008341 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8342 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008343
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008344 Supported in default-server: No
8345
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008346non-stick
8347 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8348 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8349 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8350
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008351 Supported in default-server: No
8352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008353observe <mode>
8354 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8355 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8356 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8357 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8358 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8359 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008360 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008362 Supported in default-server: No
8363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008364 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008366on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008367 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8368 Currently, four modes are available:
8369 - fastinter: force fastinter
8370 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8371 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8372 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8373 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008375 Supported in default-server: Yes
8376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008377 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8378
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008379on-marked-down <action>
8380 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8381 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008382 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8383 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8384 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8385 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8386 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8387 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8388 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8389 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008390
8391 Actions are disabled by default
8392
8393 Supported in default-server: Yes
8394
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008395on-marked-up <action>
8396 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8397 Currently one action is available:
8398 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8399 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8400 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8401 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8402 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8403 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8404 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8405 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8406
8407 Actions are disabled by default
8408
8409 Supported in default-server: Yes
8410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008411port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008412 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8413 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8414 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8415 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8416 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8417 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008419 Supported in default-server: Yes
8420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008421redir <prefix>
8422 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8423 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8424 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8425 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8426 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8427 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8428 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8429 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008430 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008431 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8432 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8433 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8434 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8435 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8436
8437 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008439 Supported in default-server: No
8440
8441rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008442 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8443 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8444 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008446 Supported in default-server: Yes
8447
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008448send-proxy
8449 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8450 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8451 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8452 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8453 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8454 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8455 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8456 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8457 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008458 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8459 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8460 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8461 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8462 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008463
8464 Supported in default-server: No
8465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008466slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008467 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8468 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8469 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8470 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8471 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8472 parameters :
8473
8474 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8475 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8476
8477 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8478 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8479 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8480 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8481
8482 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8483 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8484 seen as failed.
8485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008486 Supported in default-server: Yes
8487
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008488source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008489source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008490source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008491 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8492 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8493 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8494 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8495
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008496 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8497 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8498 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8499 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8500 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8501 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8502 server.
8503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008504 Supported in default-server: No
8505
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008506ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008507 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8508 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8509 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8510 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8511 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8512 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8513 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008514
8515 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008517track [<proxy>/]<server>
8518 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8519 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8520 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8521 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8522 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008524 Supported in default-server: No
8525
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008526verify [none|required]
8527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008528 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8529 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8530 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8531 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008532 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8533 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8534 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008535
8536 Supported in default-server: No
8537
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008538verifyhost <hostname>
8539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8540 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8541 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8542 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8543 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8544 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8545
8546 Supported in default-server: No
8547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008548weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008549 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8550 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8551 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008552 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8553 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8554 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8555 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8556 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8557 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008558
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008559 Supported in default-server: Yes
8560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008561
85626. HTTP header manipulation
8563---------------------------
8564
8565In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8566response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8567request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8568which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8569against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8570to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8571passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8572headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8573never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8574
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008575There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8576(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8577rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8578messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8579in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008580happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008581add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8582normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008584This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8585in section 4.2 :
8586
8587 - reqadd <string>
8588 - reqallow <search>
8589 - reqiallow <search>
8590 - reqdel <search>
8591 - reqidel <search>
8592 - reqdeny <search>
8593 - reqideny <search>
8594 - reqpass <search>
8595 - reqipass <search>
8596 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8597 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8598 - reqtarpit <search>
8599 - reqitarpit <search>
8600 - rspadd <string>
8601 - rspdel <search>
8602 - rspidel <search>
8603 - rspdeny <search>
8604 - rspideny <search>
8605 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8606 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8607
8608With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8609is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8610parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8611prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8612Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8613
8614 \t for a tab
8615 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8616 \n for a new line (LF)
8617 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8618 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8619 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8620 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8621 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8622
8623The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8624portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8625above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8626regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
86279 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8628is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8629
8630The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8631after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8632
8633Notes related to these keywords :
8634---------------------------------
8635 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8636 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8637 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8638
8639 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8640 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8641 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8642
8643 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8644 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8645 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8646 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8647 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8648
8649 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8650 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8651 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8652 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8653 useless headers before adding new ones.
8654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008655 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008656 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8657
8658 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8659 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8660 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8661
8662 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8663 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008664 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008665
8666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8668----------------------------------
8669
8670Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8671client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8672The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8673these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8674but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8675data called patterns.
8676
8677
86787.1. ACL basics
8679---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008680
8681The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8682content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8683from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8684simple :
8685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008686 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008687 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008688 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8689 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008691The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8692adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008693
8694In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008696 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008697
8698This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8699Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8700and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008701an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8702conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8703as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8704are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008705
8706ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8707'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8708which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8709
8710There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8711performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008713The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8714specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8715this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008716methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8717ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008718
8719Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8720 - boolean
8721 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8722 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8723 - string
8724 - data block
8725
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008726Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8727converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8728would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8729The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8730which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008732The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8733 - boolean
8734 - integer or integer range
8735 - IP address / network
8736 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8737 - regular expression
8738 - hex block
8739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008740The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8741
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008742 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8743 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008744 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008745 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008747The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8748read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8749if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8750lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8751will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8752beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8753a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8754lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8755exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8756
8757Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8758loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8759
8760 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8761
8762In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8763the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8764case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8765as well.
8766
8767The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8768sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8769do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8770methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8771is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8772obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8773followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8774default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8775that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8776string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8777
8778There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8779sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8780be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008781
8782 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8783 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008784 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8785 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8786 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8787 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008788
8789 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8790 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008791 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008792
8793 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008794 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008795
8796 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008797 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008798
8799 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8800 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8801
8802 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8803 binary or string samples.
8804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008805 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8806 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008808 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8809 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8810 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008812 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8813 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008815 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8816 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008818 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8819 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008821 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8822 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008823 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008825 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8826 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8827 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008828
8829For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8830request, it is possible to do :
8831
8832 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8833
8834In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8835buffer, one would use the following acl :
8836
8837 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8838
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008839On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8840possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8841
8842 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008844All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8845criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8846method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8847to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8848criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8849the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008851If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8852the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8853example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008855 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8856 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8857 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8858 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008859
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008860
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008861The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008862and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8863combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8864the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008866 +-------------------------------------------------+
8867 | Input sample type |
8868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8869 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8871 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008873 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008875 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008877 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008879 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008881 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008883 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008885 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008887 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008889 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008891 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008893 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8895 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008897
8898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088997.1.1. Matching booleans
8900------------------------
8901
8902In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8903Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8904When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8905that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8906
8907Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8908return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8909"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8910
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089127.1.2. Matching integers
8913------------------------
8914
8915Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8916enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8917to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8918
8919Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8920matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8921lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008922
8923For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8924unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8925representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8926
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008927As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8928two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8929instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8930ranges and operators.
8931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008932For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008933operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8934Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8935of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008937Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008938
8939 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8940 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8941 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8942 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8943 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008945For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008946
8947 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8948
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008949This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8950
8951 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8952
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089547.1.3. Matching strings
8955-----------------------
8956
8957String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8958different forms :
8959
8960 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8961 patterns ;
8962
8963 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8964 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8965
8966 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8967 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8968
8969 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8970 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8971
8972 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8973 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8974 matches.
8975
8976 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8977 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8978 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008979
8980String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8981exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8982characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8983string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8984to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008985before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008986
8987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089887.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8989---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008990
8991Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8992they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8993possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8994passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8995the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008996the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8997match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008998
8999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090007.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9001-------------------------------------
9002
9003It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9004not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9005a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9006to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9007digits may be used upper or lower case.
9008
9009Example :
9010 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9011 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9012
9013
90147.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9015---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009016
9017IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9018netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9019within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009020host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009021difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9022at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9023does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9024parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009025
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009026IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9027Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9028trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9029IPv6 patterns.
9030
9031HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9032following situations :
9033 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9034 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9035 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9036 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9037 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9038 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9039 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9040 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9041 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9042 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009044
90457.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9046----------------------------------
9047
9048Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9049combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9050
9051 - AND (implicit)
9052 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9053 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009055A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009057 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009059Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9060indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009062For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9063"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9064requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9065is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9066
9067 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9068 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9069 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9070 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9071
9072To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9073and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9074
9075 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9076 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9077 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9078 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9079
9080 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9081 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9082 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9083 use_backend www if host_www
9084
9085It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9086expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9087be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9088the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9089
9090 The following rule :
9091
9092 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9093 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9094
9095 Can also be written that way :
9096
9097 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9098
9099It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9100to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9101simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9102sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9103good use is the following :
9104
9105 With named ACLs :
9106
9107 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9108 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9109 monitor fail if site_dead
9110
9111 With anonymous ACLs :
9112
9113 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9114
9115See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9116
9117
91187.3. Fetching samples
9119---------------------
9120
9121Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9122against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9123sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9124ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9125of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9126available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9127
9128This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9129Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9130compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9131deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9132
9133The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9134matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9135method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9136indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9137
9138As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9139when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9140mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9141the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9142ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9143
9144Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9145multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9146when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9147incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9148are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9149is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9150all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9151
9152Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9153 - name
9154 - name(arg1)
9155 - name(arg1,arg2)
9156
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009157Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9158of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9159is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9160was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9161has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9162unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9163
9164These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9165sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9166the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9167support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009169The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009171 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9172 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9173 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009175 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9176 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9177 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009179 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9180 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9181 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9182 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9183 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9184
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009185 http_date([<offset>])
9186 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9187 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9188 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9189 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9190 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9191 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9192 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9193 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009194
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009195 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9196 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9197 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9198 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9199 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9200 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9201 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9202 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9203 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9204 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9205 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9206 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9207 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9208 the map* converters.
9209
9210 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9211 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9212 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9213 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9214
9215 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9216 | `-_ out | | | |
9217 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9218 | / match `-_ | | | |
9219 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9220 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9221 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9222 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9223 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9224 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9225 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9226 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9227 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9228 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9229
9230 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9231 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9232 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9233 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9234 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9235 trailing spaces/tabs.
9236
9237 Example :
9238
9239 # this is a comment and is ignored
9240 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9241 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9242 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9243 | | | `----------- value
9244 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9245 | `---------------------------- key
9246 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092487.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9249--------------------------------------------
9250
9251A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9252not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9253"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9254The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9255
9256always_false : boolean
9257 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9258 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9259
9260always_true : boolean
9261 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9262 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9263
9264avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009265 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009266 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9267 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9268 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9269 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9270 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9271 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9272 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9273 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9274 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9275 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9276 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9277 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9278 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009280be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009281 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9282 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9283 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9284 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9285 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009287be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9288 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9289 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9290 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9291 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9292 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9293 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009294
9295 Example :
9296 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9297 backend dynamic
9298 mode http
9299 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9300 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009302connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9304 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9305 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9306 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009307
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009308 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009309 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009310 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9311
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009312 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9313 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009314
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009315 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009316 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009317 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009318 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9319 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009320 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009321 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009322
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009323 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9324 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009325 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009326 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009327
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009328date([<offset>]) : integer
9329 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9330 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9331 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9332 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009333 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9334
9335 Example :
9336
9337 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9338 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009339
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009340env(<name>) : string
9341 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9342 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9343 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9344 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9345 certain way.
9346
9347 Examples :
9348 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9349 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9350
9351 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9352 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009354fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9355 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009356 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9357 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009358 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9359 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9360 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9361 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9362 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009364fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9365 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9366 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9367 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9368 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9369 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9370 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9371 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9372 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009373
9374 Example :
9375 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9376 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9377 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9378 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9379 frontend mail
9380 bind :25
9381 mode tcp
9382 maxconn 100
9383 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9384 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9385 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9386 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009388nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9389 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9390 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9391 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009392 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9393 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9394 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009396queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009397 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9398 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9399 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009400 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9401 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9402 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9403 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9404 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9405
9406srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9407 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9408 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9409 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9410 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9411 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9412 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9413 methods.
9414
9415srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9416 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9417 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9418 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9419 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9420 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9421 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9422 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9423
9424srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9425 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9426 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9427 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9428 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9429 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9430 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9431 overloading servers).
9432
9433 Example :
9434 # Redirect to a separate back
9435 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9436 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9437 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9438
9439table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9440 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9441 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9442
9443table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9444 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9445 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9446 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9447
9448
94497.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9450----------------------------------
9451
9452The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9453closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9454methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9455sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9456TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009457the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9458counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9459"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009460argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9461the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9462this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009463
9464be_id : integer
9465 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9466 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9467
9468dst : ip
9469 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9470 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9471 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9472 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9473 RFC 4291.
9474
9475dst_conn : integer
9476 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9477 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9478 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9479 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9480 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9481 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9482 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9483 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009485dst_port : integer
9486 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9487 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9488 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9489 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9490 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9491 an HTTP header.
9492
9493fe_id : integer
9494 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9495 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9496 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9497
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009498sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9499sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9500sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9501sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009502 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9503 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9504 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9505
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009506sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9507sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9508sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9509sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009510 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9511 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9512 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9513
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009514sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9515sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9516sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9517sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009518 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9519 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009520 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9521 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9522 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009523
9524 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9525 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009526 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9527 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9528 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009529 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9530 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9531
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009532sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9533sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9534sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9535sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009536 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9537 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9538
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009539sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9540sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9541sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9542sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009543 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9544 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9545 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9546
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009547sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9548sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9549sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9550sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009551 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9552 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9553 See also src_conn_rate.
9554
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009555sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9556sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9557sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9558sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009559 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009560 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009561
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009562sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9563sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9564sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9565sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009566 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9567 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9568 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009569 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9570 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9571 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009573sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9574sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9575sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9576sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009577 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9578 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9579 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9580
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009581sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9582sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9583sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9584sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009585 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9586 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9587 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9588 src_http_err_rate.
9589
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009590sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9591sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9592sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9593sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9595 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9596 src_http_req_cnt.
9597
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009598sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9599sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9600sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9601sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009602 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9603 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9604 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9605 src_http_req_rate.
9606
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009607sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9608sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9609sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9610sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009611 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009612 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9613 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9614 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9615 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009616
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009617 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9618 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009619 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9620
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009621sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9622sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9623sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9624sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009625 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9626 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9627 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9628 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9629
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009630sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9631sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9632sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9633sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009634 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9635 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9636 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9637 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9638
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009639sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9640sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9641sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9642sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009643 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9644 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9645 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9646 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009647 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009648 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9649
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009650sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9651sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9652sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9653sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009654 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9655 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9656 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9657 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9658 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009659 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009660
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009661sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9662sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9663sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9664sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009665 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9666 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9667 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9668
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009669sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9670sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9671sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9672sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009673 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9674 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009675 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009676 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9677 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009678 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9679 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9680 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009682so_id : integer
9683 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9684 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9685 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687src : ip
9688 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9689 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9690 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9691 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9692 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9693 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9694 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009695
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009696 Example:
9697 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9698 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009700src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9701 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9702 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9703 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009704 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009706src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9707 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9708 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009709 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009710 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009712src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9713 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9714 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9715 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9716 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9717 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9718 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009719
9720 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9721 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9722 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9723 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009724 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009725 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9726 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009728src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009729 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009730 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009731 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009732 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009734src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009735 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009736 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9737 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009738 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009740src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9741 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9742 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9743 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009744 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009746src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009747 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009749 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009750 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009752src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009753 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009755 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9756 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009757 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9758 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9759 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9762 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9763 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009764 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009765 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009766 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009768src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9769 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9770 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9771 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9772 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009773 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009775src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9776 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9777 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9778 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009779 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9782 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9783 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9784 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009785 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009786 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009788src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9789 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9790 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9791 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009792 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009793 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9794 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009795
9796 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009797 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009800src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9801 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9802 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9803 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9804 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009805 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9806 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9809 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9810 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009811 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9812 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009813 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009815src_port : integer
9816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9817 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9818 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9819 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009821src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9822 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009823 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9824 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9825 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009826 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009828src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9829 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9830 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9831 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9832 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009833 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009835src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9836 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9837 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9838 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9839 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9840 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9841 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9842 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9843 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009844
9845 Example :
9846 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9847 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9848 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9849 listen ssh
9850 bind :22
9851 mode tcp
9852 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009853 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009854 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009855 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009857srv_id : integer
9858 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9859 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9860 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009861
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098637.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9864----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009866The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9867closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9868when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9869usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9870future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009872ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9873 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9874 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9875 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9876 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9877 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009879ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9880 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9881 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9882 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9883 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009885ssl_c_err : integer
9886 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9887 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9888 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9889 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9890 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009892ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9893 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9894 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9895 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9896 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9897 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9898 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9899 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9900 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009902 ACL derivatives :
9903 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009905ssl_c_key_alg : string
9906 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9907 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9908 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910 ACL derivatives :
9911 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009913ssl_c_notafter : string
9914 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9915 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9916 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009918 ACL derivatives :
9919 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921ssl_c_notbefore : string
9922 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9923 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9924 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926 ACL derivatives :
9927 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009929ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9930 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9931 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9932 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9933 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9934 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9935 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9936 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9937 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939 ACL derivatives :
9940 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009942ssl_c_serial : binary
9943 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9944 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9945 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947 ACL derivatives :
9948 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009950ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9951 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9952 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9953 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9956 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9957 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9958 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009960 ACL derivatives :
9961 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9962
9963ssl_c_used : boolean
9964 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9965 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009967ssl_c_verify : integer
9968 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9969 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9970 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9971 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009973ssl_c_version : integer
9974 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9975 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009977ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9978 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9979 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9980 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9981 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009982 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009983 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9984 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9985 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987 ACL derivatives :
9988 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990ssl_f_key_alg : string
9991 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9992 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9993 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995 ACL derivatives :
9996 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998ssl_f_notafter : string
9999 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10000 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10001 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003 ACL derivatives :
10004 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006ssl_f_notbefore : string
10007 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10008 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10009 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010011 ACL derivatives :
10012 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010014ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10015 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10016 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10017 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10018 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10019 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10020 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10021 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10022 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010024 ACL derivatives :
10025 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027ssl_f_serial : binary
10028 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10029 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10030 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032 ACL derivatives :
10033 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010035ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10036 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10037 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10038 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040 ACL derivatives :
10041 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010043ssl_f_version : integer
10044 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10045 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10046
10047ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010048 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10049 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10050 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010052 Example :
10053 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10054 listen http-https
10055 bind :80
10056 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10057 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10058
10059ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10060 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10061 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10062
10063ssl_fc_alpn : string
10064 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10065 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10066 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10067 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10068 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10069 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10070 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10071 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10072 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10073
10074 ACL derivatives :
10075 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077ssl_fc_cipher : string
10078 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10079 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081 ACL derivatives :
10082 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010085 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10086 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010087 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10088 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10089 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10090 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010092ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10093 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010094 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10095 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10096 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10097 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010099ssl_fc_npn : string
10100 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10101 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10102 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10103 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10104 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10105 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10106 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10107 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010109 ACL derivatives :
10110 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112ssl_fc_protocol : string
10113 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10114 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010116 ACL derivatives :
10117 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10118
10119ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10120 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10121 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10122 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10123 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010125ssl_fc_sni : string
10126 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10127 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10128 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10129 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10130 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10131
10132 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10133 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10134 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010135 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10136 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138 ACL derivatives :
10139 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10140 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10141 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10144 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10145 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010146
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101487.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10149------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10152sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10153only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10154For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10155be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10156can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10157sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10158for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10159content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10162 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10163 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10164 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010166payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10167 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10168 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10169 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010171req.len : integer
10172req_len : integer (deprecated)
10173 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10174 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10175 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10176 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10177 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10178 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10179 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10180 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10183 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010184 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10185 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10186 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10187 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010189 ACL alternatives :
10190 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010192req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10193 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10194 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10195 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10196 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198 ACL alternatives :
10199 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203req.proto_http : boolean
10204req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10205 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10206 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10207 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10208 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10209 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10210 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10211 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010213 Example:
10214 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10215 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10216 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010217 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010219req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10220rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10221 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10222 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10223 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10224 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10225 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10226 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10227 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10230 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10231 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10232 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10233 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10234 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236 ACL derivatives :
10237 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010239 Example :
10240 listen tse-farm
10241 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10242 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10243 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10244 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10245 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10246 persist rdp-cookie
10247 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10248 # This is only useful makes sense if
10249 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10250 stick-table type string size 204800
10251 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10252 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10253 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010255 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10256 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10259rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10260 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10261 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10262 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10263 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265 ACL derivatives :
10266 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010268req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10269req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10270 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10271 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10272 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10273 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10274 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10275 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10276 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278req.ssl_sni : string
10279req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10280 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10281 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10282 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10283 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10284 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10285 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10286 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10287 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10288 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10289 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10290 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10291 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 ACL derivatives :
10294 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010296 Examples :
10297 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10298 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10299 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10300 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10301 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10304rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10305 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10306 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10307 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10308 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10309 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10310 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10311 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010313req.ssl_ver : integer
10314req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10315 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10316 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10317 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10318 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10319 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10320 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10321 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10322 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10323 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010325 ACL derivatives :
10326 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010327
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010328res.len : integer
10329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10330 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10331 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10332 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10333 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10334 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10335 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10336 content inspection.
10337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010338res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10339 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010340 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10341 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10342 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10343 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010345res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10346 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10347 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10348 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10349 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010351 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010353wait_end : boolean
10354 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10355 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10356 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10357 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10358 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10359 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10360 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10361 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010363 Examples :
10364 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10365 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10366 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10369 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10370 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10371 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10372 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10373 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10374 tcp-request content reject
10375
10376
103777.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10378--------------------------------------
10379
10380It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10381This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10382data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10383its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10384HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10385content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10386to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10387more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10388response are indexed.
10389
10390base : string
10391 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10392 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10393 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10394 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10395 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10396 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10397 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10398 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10399
10400 ACL derivatives :
10401 base : exact string match
10402 base_beg : prefix match
10403 base_dir : subdir match
10404 base_dom : domain match
10405 base_end : suffix match
10406 base_len : length match
10407 base_reg : regex match
10408 base_sub : substring match
10409
10410base32 : integer
10411 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10412 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10413 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10414 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10415
10416base32+src : binary
10417 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10418 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10419 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10420 per-URL counters.
10421
10422req.cook([<name>]) : string
10423cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10424 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10425 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10426 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10427 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10428 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10429 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10430 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10431 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10432
10433 ACL derivatives :
10434 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10435 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10436 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10437 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10438 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10439 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10440 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10441 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010443req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10444cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10445 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10446 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010448req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10449cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10450 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10451 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10452 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10453 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010455cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10456 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10457 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10458 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10459 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10460 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10461 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10462 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10463 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10464 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10465 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010466
William Lallemanda43ba4e2014-01-28 18:14:25 +010010467capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10468 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10469 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10470 See also: "capture request header"
10471
10472capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10473 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10474 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10475 See also: "capture response header"
10476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010477hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10478 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10479 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10480 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10481 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10482 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010484req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10485 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10486 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10487 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10488 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10489 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10490 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10491 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10492 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010494req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10495 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10496 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10497 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10498 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010500req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10501 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10502 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10503 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10504 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10505 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10506 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10507 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10508 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10509 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10510 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10511 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513 ACL derivatives :
10514 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10515 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10516 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10517 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10518 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10519 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10520 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10521 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10522
10523req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10524hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10525 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10526 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10527 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10528 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10529 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10530 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10531 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10532 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10533 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10534
10535req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10536hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10537 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10538 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10539 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10540 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10541 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10542 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10543 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10544 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10545
10546req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10547hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10548 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10549 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10550 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10551 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10552 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10553 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10554 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10555
10556http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10557 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10558 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10559 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10560 basic auth is supported.
10561
10562http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10563 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10564 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10565 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10566 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10567 basic auth is supported.
10568
10569 ACL derivatives :
10570 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10571
10572http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010573 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10574 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010575 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10576 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578method : integer + string
10579 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10580 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10581 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10582 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10583 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10584 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10585 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587 ACL derivatives :
10588 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590 Example :
10591 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10592 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10593 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010595path : string
10596 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10597 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10598 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10599 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10600 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10601 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10602 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604 ACL derivatives :
10605 path : exact string match
10606 path_beg : prefix match
10607 path_dir : subdir match
10608 path_dom : domain match
10609 path_end : suffix match
10610 path_len : length match
10611 path_reg : regex match
10612 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614req.ver : string
10615req_ver : string (deprecated)
10616 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10617 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10618 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620 ACL derivatives :
10621 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010623res.comp : boolean
10624 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10625 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10626 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628res.comp_algo : string
10629 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10630 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10631 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633res.cook([<name>]) : string
10634scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10635 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10636 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10637 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639 ACL derivatives :
10640 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010642res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10643scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10644 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10645 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10646 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10649scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10650 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10651 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10652 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010654res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10655 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10656 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10657 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10658 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10659 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10660 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10661 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10662 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10663 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010665res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10666 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10667 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10668 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10669 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10670 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010672res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10673shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10674 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10675 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10676 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10677 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10678 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10679 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10680 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10681 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683 ACL derivatives :
10684 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10685 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10686 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10687 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10688 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10689 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10690 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10691 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10692
10693res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10694shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10695 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10696 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10697 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10698 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10699 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10702shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10703 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10704 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10705 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10706 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10707 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10708 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010710res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10711shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10712 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10713 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10714 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10715 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10716 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10717 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010719res.ver : string
10720resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10721 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10722 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010724 ACL derivatives :
10725 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010727set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10728 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10729 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10730 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10731 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10734 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010736 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010738status : integer
10739 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10740 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10741 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010743url : string
10744 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10745 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10746 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10747 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10748 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10749 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10750 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752 ACL derivatives :
10753 url : exact string match
10754 url_beg : prefix match
10755 url_dir : subdir match
10756 url_dom : domain match
10757 url_end : suffix match
10758 url_len : length match
10759 url_reg : regex match
10760 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010762url_ip : ip
10763 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10764 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10765 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10766 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10767 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10768 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10769 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771url_port : integer
10772 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10773 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10774 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10775 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010777urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10778url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10779 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10780 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10781 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10782 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10783 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10784 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10785 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10786 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10787 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010789 ACL derivatives :
10790 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10791 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10792 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10793 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10794 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10795 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10796 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10797 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010798
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010800 Example :
10801 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10802 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10803 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10804 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10807 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10808 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10809 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010810
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108127.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010813---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010815Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10816every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010817order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010819ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10820---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010821FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010822HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010823HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10824HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010825HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10826HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10827HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10828HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10829LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010830METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10831METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10832METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10833METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10834METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10835METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010836RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010837REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010838TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010839WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10840---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010841
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108438. Logging
10844----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010845
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010846One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10847provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10848very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10849provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10850state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010851to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010852headers.
10853
10854In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10855about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10856send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10857
10858 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10859 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10860 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10861 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10862 at the termination.
10863
10864The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10865allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10866as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10867while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10868real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10869delay.
10870
10871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108728.1. Log levels
10873---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010874
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010875TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010876source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010877HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10878in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10879track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10880syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10881about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010882
10883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108848.2. Log formats
10885----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010886
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010887HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010888and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10889slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10890options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010891
10892 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10893 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10894 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10895 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10896 extents.
10897
10898 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10899 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10900 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10901 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10902 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10903
10904 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10905 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10906 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10907 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10908 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10909
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010910 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10911 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10912 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10913 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10914
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010915 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10916
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010917Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10918specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10919field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10920servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10921always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10922identifier.
10923
10924Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10925 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10926 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10927 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10928 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10929
10930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109318.2.1. Default log format
10932-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010933
10934This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10935as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10936format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10937
10938 Example :
10939 listen www
10940 mode http
10941 log global
10942 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10943
10944 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10945 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10946 (www/HTTP)
10947
10948 Field Format Extract from the example above
10949 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10950 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10951 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10952 4 'to' to
10953 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10954 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10955
10956Detailed fields description :
10957 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10958 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10959 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10960 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10961 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10962 and processed the connection.
10963 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10964
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010965In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10966"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10967connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10968
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010969It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10970will eventually disappear.
10971
10972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109738.2.2. TCP log format
10974---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010975
10976The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10977is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10978information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10979counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10980emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10981environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10982the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10983sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010984specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10985not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10986fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10987marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010988
10989 Example :
10990 frontend fnt
10991 mode tcp
10992 option tcplog
10993 log global
10994 default_backend bck
10995
10996 backend bck
10997 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10998
10999 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11000 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11001 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11002
11003 Field Format Extract from the example above
11004 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11005 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11006 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11007 4 frontend_name fnt
11008 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11009 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11010 7 bytes_read* 212
11011 8 termination_state --
11012 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11013 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11014
11015Detailed fields description :
11016 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011017 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11018 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11019 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11020 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11021 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011022
11023 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011024 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11025 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11026 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011027
11028 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11029 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11030 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11031 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11032
11033 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11034 and processed the connection.
11035
11036 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11037 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11038 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11039 applications.
11040
11041 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11042 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11043 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11044 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11045 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11046
11047 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11048 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11049 See "Timers" below for more details.
11050
11051 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11052 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11053 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11054 "Timers" below for more details.
11055
11056 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11057 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11058 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11059 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11060 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11061 details.
11062
11063 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11064 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11065 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11066 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11067 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11068
11069 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11070 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11071 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11072 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11073 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11074 for more details.
11075
11076 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011077 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011078 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11079 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11080 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011081 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011082
11083 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11084 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11085 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11086 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11087 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11088 caused by a denial of service attack.
11089
11090 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11091 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11092 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11093 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11094 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11095 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11096 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11097 denial of service attack.
11098
11099 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11100 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11101 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11102 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11103 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11104 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11105 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11106 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11107 be processed than on other servers.
11108
11109 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11110 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11111 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11112 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11113 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11114 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11115 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11116 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11117 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11118 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11119 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11120 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11121 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11122
11123 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11124 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11125 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11126 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11127 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11128 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11129 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11130 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11131
11132 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11133 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11134 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11135 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11136 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11137 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11138 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11139 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11140 occurs.
11141
11142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111438.2.3. HTTP log format
11144----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011145
11146The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11147is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11148the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11149are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11150emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11151generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11152"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11153which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011154frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11155is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011156
11157Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11158slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11159with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11160
11161 Example :
11162 frontend http-in
11163 mode http
11164 option httplog
11165 log global
11166 default_backend bck
11167
11168 backend static
11169 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11170
11171 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11172 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11173 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011174 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011175
11176 Field Format Extract from the example above
11177 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11178 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11179 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11180 4 frontend_name http-in
11181 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11182 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11183 7 status_code 200
11184 8 bytes_read* 2750
11185 9 captured_request_cookie -
11186 10 captured_response_cookie -
11187 11 termination_state ----
11188 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11189 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11190 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11191 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11192 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011194
11195Detailed fields description :
11196 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011197 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11198 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11199 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11200 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11201 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011202
11203 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011204 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11205 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11206 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011207
11208 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11209 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11210 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11211 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11212 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11213
11214 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11215 and processed the connection.
11216
11217 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11218 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11219 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11220
11221 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11222 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11223 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11224 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11225 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11226 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11227
11228 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11229 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11230 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11231 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11232 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11233 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11234
11235 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11236 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11237 See "Timers" below for more details.
11238
11239 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11240 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11241 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11242 below for more details.
11243
11244 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11245 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11246 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11247 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11248 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11249 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11250 for more details.
11251
11252 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11253 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11254 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11255 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11256 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11257 details.
11258
11259 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11260 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11261 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11262
11263 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11264 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11265 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11266 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11267 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11268 overflowing.
11269
11270 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11271 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11272 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11273 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11274 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11275 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11276 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11277 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11278
11279 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11280 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11281 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11282 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11283 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11284 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11285 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11286 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11287
11288 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11289 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11290 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11291 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11292 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11293 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11294 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11295
11296 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011297 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011298 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11299 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11300 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011301 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011302 system.
11303
11304 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11305 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11306 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11307 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11308 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11309 caused by a denial of service attack.
11310
11311 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11312 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11313 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11314 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11315 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11316 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11317 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11318 denial of service attack.
11319
11320 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11321 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11322 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11323 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11324 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11325 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11326 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11327 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11328 processed than on other servers.
11329
11330 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11331 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11332 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11333 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11334 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11335 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11336 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11337 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11338 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11339 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11340 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11341 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11342 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11343
11344 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11345 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11346 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11347 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11348 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11349 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11350 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11351 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11352
11353 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11354 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11355 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11356 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11357 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11358 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11359 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11360 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11361 occurs.
11362
11363 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11364 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11365 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11366 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11367 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11368 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11369 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11370 cookies" below for more details.
11371
11372 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11373 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11374 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11375 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11376 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11377 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11378 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11379 and cookies" below for more details.
11380
11381 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11382 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11383 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11384 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11385 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11386 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11387 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11388 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11389
11390
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200113918.2.4. Custom log format
11392------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011393
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011394The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011395mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011396
11397HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11398Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11399separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11400prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11401
11402Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11403variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11404string formats ("Q").
11405
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011406If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011407as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011408less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11409the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11410
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011411Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011412In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11413in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011414
11415Flags are :
11416 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011417 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011418
11419 Example:
11420
11421 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11422 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11423
11424At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11425
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011426 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11427 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011428
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011429the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011430
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011431 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011432 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011433 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011434
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011435and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11436
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011437 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011438 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11439
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011440Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11441
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011442 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011443 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011444 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11445 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11446 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011447 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11448 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11449 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011450 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011451 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011452 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011453 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011454 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011455 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011456 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11457 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011458 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011459 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11460 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011461 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011462 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11463 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011464 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11465 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11466 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011467 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011468 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11469 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011470 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011471 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11472 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11473 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011474 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011475 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11476 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11477 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11478 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011479 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011480 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011481 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011482 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011483 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011484 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011485 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11486 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11487 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011488 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011489 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11490 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011491 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011492 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011493 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011494 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011495
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011496 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011497
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011498
114998.2.5. Error log format
11500-----------------------
11501
11502When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11503protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11504By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11505"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11506will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11507logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11508
11509The format looks like this :
11510
11511 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11512 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11513 Connection error during SSL handshake
11514
11515 Field Format Extract from the example above
11516 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11517 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11518 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11519 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11520 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11521
11522These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11523failures.
11524
11525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115268.3. Advanced logging options
11527-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011528
11529Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11530just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11531options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11532for more information about their usage.
11533
11534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11536------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011537
11538It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11539haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11540commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11541monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11542ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11543
11544 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11545 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11546 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11547 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11548
11549 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11550 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11551 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11552 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11553 such as other load-balancers.
11554
11555 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11556 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11557 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11558
11559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115608.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11561----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011562
11563The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11564what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11565or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11566"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11567just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11568log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11569after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11570is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11571with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11572with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11573
11574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115758.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11576------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011577
11578Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11579for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11580"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11581retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11582raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11583a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11584file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11585you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11586"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11587
11588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115898.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11590--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011591
11592Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11593multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11594them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11595"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11596logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11597error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11598and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11599too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11600useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11601alternative.
11602
11603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116048.4. Timing events
11605------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011606
11607Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11608reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11609the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11610frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11611mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11612
11613 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11614 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11615 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11616 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11617 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11618
11619 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11620 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11621 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11622 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11623 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11624
11625 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11626 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11627 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11628 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11629 connection never established.
11630
11631 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11632 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11633 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11634 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11635 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11636 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11637 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11638 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11639 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11640 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11641 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11642
11643 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11644 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11645 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11646 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11647 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11648
11649 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11650
11651 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11652 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11653 negative.
11654
11655These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11656protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11657that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011658due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011659close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11660session has been aborted on timeout.
11661
11662Most common cases :
11663
11664 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11665 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11666 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11667 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11668 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11669 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11670 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11671 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11672 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011673 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11674 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11675 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011676
11677 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11678 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11679 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11680 of ms on remote networks.
11681
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011682 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11683 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11684 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011685
11686 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11687 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11688 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11689 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11690 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11691 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11692 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11693 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11694 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11695 to the server until another one is released.
11696
11697Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11698
11699 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11700 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11701 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11702
11703 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11704 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11705 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11706
11707 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11708 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11709 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11710 flags.
11711
11712 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11713 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11714 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11715 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11716 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11717 the client connection was maintained open.
11718
11719 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11720 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11721 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11722 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11723
11724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117258.5. Session state at disconnection
11726-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011727
11728TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11729"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
117302-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11731each of which has a special meaning :
11732
11733 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11734 session to terminate :
11735
11736 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11737
11738 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11739 server explicitly refused it.
11740
11741 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11742 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11743 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11744 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011745 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11746
11747 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11748 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011749
11750 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11751 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11752 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11753 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11754 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11755
11756 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11757 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11758 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11759 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11760 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11761
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011762 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11763 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11764
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011765 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11766 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11767 backup connections when going up.
11768
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011769 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11770
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011771 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11772 send or receive data.
11773
11774 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11775 send or receive data.
11776
11777 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11778 with nothing left in the buffers.
11779
11780 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11781
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011782 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011783 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11784
11785 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11786 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11787 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11788 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11789 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11790
11791 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11792 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11793
11794 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11795 server (HTTP only).
11796
11797 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11798
11799 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11800 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11801 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11802
11803 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11804 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11805 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11806
11807 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11808
11809 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11810 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11811
11812 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11813 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11814 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11815
11816 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11817 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011818 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11819 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820
11821 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11822 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11823 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11824 another server.
11825
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011826 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011827 server.
11828
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011829 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11830 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11831 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11832 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11833
11834 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11835 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11836 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11837 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11838
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011839 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11840 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11841 "use-server" rule).
11842
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011843 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11844
11845 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11846 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11847
11848 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11849
11850 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11851 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11852 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11853
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011854 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11855 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11856 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11857 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11858 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11859
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011860 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11861
11862 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11863 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11864
11865 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11866
11867 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11868
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011869The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11870was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011871helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11872starvation, attacks, etc...
11873
11874The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11875alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11876easier finding and understanding.
11877
11878 Flags Reason
11879
11880 -- Normal termination.
11881
11882 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11883 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11884 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11885 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11886
11887 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11888 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11889 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11890 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11891 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11892 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011893
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011894 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11895 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011896 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011897
11898 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11899 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11900 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11901
11902 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11903 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11904 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11905 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11906 the server takes too long to respond.
11907
11908 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11909 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11910 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11911 long a time to respond.
11912
11913 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11914 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11915 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11916 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11917 and the client.
11918
11919 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11920 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11921 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11922 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11923 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11924 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11925
11926 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11927 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011928 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11929 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11930 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11931 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011932
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011933 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11934 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011936 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011937 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11938 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11939 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11940 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11941 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11942
11943 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11944 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11945 503 or 504 here.
11946
11947 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11948 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11949 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11950 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11951 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11952
11953 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11954 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011955 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011956 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11957 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11958
11959 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11960 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11961 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11962 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11963 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11964 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11965 between haproxy and the server.
11966
11967 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11968 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11969 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11970 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11971 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11972 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11973 solution is to fix the application.
11974
11975 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11976 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11977 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11978 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11979 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11980 external attacks.
11981
11982 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11983 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011984 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011985 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11986 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11987
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011988 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11989 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11990 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011991 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11992 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011994 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11995 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11996 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11997 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011998 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11999 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12000 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12001 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12002 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012003
12004 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12005 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12006 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12007 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12008
12009 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12010 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12011 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12012 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12013
12014 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12015 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12016 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12017 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12018
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012019The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12020persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12021important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12022re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12023
12024 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12025
12026 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12027 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12028 set on a GET request.
12029
12030 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12031 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012032 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012033 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12034
12035 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12036 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12037 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12038
12039 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12040 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12041 already got a cookie.
12042
12043 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12044 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12045 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12046 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12047 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12048
12049 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12050 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12051 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12052
12053 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12054 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12055 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12056
12057 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12058 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12059
12060 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12061 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12062 then advertised in the response.
12063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120658.6. Non-printable characters
12066-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012067
12068In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12069consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12070converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12071prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12072being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12073escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12074is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12075'}' when logging headers.
12076
12077Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12078issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12079containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12080
12081Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12082the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12083performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12084
12085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12087---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012088
12089Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12090achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012091section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012092cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12093the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12094the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012095locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012096not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12097user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12098a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12099wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12100
12101 Examples :
12102 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12103 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12104
12105 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12106 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12107
12108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121098.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12110---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012111
12112Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12113proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12114the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12115server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12116
12117Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12118response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012119section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012120
12121It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012122time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12123appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012124are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12125and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12126follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12127request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12128in the logs.
12129
12130 Example :
12131 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12132 listen proxy-out
12133 mode http
12134 option httplog
12135 option logasap
12136 log global
12137 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12138
12139 # log the name of the virtual server
12140 capture request header Host len 20
12141
12142 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12143 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12144
12145 # log the beginning of the referrer
12146 capture request header Referer len 20
12147
12148 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12149 capture response header Server len 20
12150
12151 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12152 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12153
12154 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12155 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12156
12157 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12158 capture response header Via len 20
12159
12160 # log the URL location during a redirection
12161 capture response header Location len 20
12162
12163 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12164 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12165 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12166 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12167 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12168
12169 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12170 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12171 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12172 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012173 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012174
12175 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12176 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12177 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12178 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12179 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012180 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012181
12182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121838.9. Examples of logs
12184---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012185
12186These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12187them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12188reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12189
12190 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12191 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12192 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12193
12194 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12195 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12196
12197 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12198 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12199 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12200
12201 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12202 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12203
12204 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12205 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12206 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12207
12208 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012209 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012210 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12211 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12212
12213 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12214 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12215 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12216
12217 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12218 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012219 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012220 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12221 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12222 to return the 502 and not the server.
12223
12224 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012225 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012226
12227 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12228 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12229 Nothing was sent to any server.
12230
12231 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12232 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12233
12234 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12235 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12236 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12237 send a 408 return code to the client.
12238
12239 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12240 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12241
12242 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12243 5 seconds ("c----").
12244
12245 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12246 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012247 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012248
12249 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012250 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012251 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12252 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12253 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12254 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12255 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012256
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122589. Statistics and monitoring
12259----------------------------
12260
12261It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12262mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12263CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12264Unix socket.
12265
12266
122679.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012268---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012269
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012270The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12271page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012273 0. pxname: proxy name
12274 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12275 for server)
12276 2. qcur: current queued requests
12277 3. qmax: max queued requests
12278 4. scur: current sessions
12279 5. smax: max sessions
12280 6. slim: sessions limit
12281 7. stot: total sessions
12282 8. bin: bytes in
12283 9. bout: bytes out
12284 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012285 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012286 12. ereq: request errors
12287 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012288 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012289 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12290 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012291 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012292 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12293 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12294 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12295 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12296 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12297 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12298 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12299 25. qlimit: queue limit
12300 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12301 27. iid: unique proxy id
12302 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12303 29. throttle: warm up status
12304 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12305 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012306 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012307 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12308 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12309 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012310 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012311 UNK -> unknown
12312 INI -> initializing
12313 SOCKERR -> socket error
12314 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12315 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12316 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12317 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12318 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12319 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12320 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12321 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12322 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12323 disable-on-404
12324 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12325 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12326 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012327 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12328 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012329 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12330 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12331 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12332 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12333 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12334 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012335 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12336 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12337 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12338 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012339 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12340 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012341 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12342 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12343 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012344 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012345
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123479.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012348-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012349
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012350The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12351necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12352A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12353issuing commands by hand :
12354
12355 global
12356 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12357 stats timeout 2m
12358
12359It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12360the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12361never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12362situations :
12363
12364 global
12365 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12366 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12367 stats timeout 2m
12368
12369To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12370swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12371to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12372syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12373
12374 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12375 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12376
12377The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12378script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12379for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12380
12381The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12382that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12383editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12384(eg: watch a counter).
12385
12386The socket supports two operation modes :
12387 - interactive
12388 - non-interactive
12389
12390The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12391this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12392sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12393mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12394commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12395example :
12396
12397 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12398
12399The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12400entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12401for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12402sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12403"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12404after processing the last command of the same line.
12405
12406For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12407"prompt" command :
12408
12409 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12410 prompt
12411 > show info
12412 ...
12413 >
12414
12415Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12416delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12417that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12418parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012419
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012420It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12421on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12422own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012423
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012424The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12425If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12426all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12427it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12428
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012429add map <map> <key> <value>
12430 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12431 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12432 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12433
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012434clear counters
12435 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12436 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12437 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12438 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12439 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12440
12441clear counters all
12442 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12443 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12444 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12445
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012446clear map <map>
12447 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12448
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012449clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12450 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12451
12452 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12453 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12454 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12455 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12456 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12457 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12458
12459 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12460
12461 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12462 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12463 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12464 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12465 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12466 the ACLs :
12467
12468 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12469 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12470 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12471 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12472 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12473 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12474
12475 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012476 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12477 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012478
12479 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012480 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012481 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012482 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12483 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12484 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12485 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012486
12487 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12488
12489 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012490 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012491 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12492 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012493 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12494 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12495 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012496
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012497enable agent <backend>/<server>
12498 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12499
12500 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12501 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12502 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12503 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12504 re-enabled using enable agent.
12505
12506 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12507 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12508 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12509 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12510 otherwise unchanged.
12511
12512 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12513 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12514 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12515
12516 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12517 level "admin".
12518
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012519del map <map> <key>
12520 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12521
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012522disable frontend <frontend>
12523 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12524 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12525 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12526 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12527 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12528 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12529 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12530 on the stats page.
12531
12532 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12533 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12534
12535 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12536 level "admin".
12537
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012538disable server <backend>/<server>
12539 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12540 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12541 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12542 during the maintenance.
12543
12544 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12545 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12546
12547 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012548 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012549
12550 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12551 level "admin".
12552
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012553enable agent <backend>/<server>
12554 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12555
12556 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12557 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12558
12559 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12560 level "admin".
12561
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012562enable frontend <frontend>
12563 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12564 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12565 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12566 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12567 which was disabled.
12568
12569 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12570 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12571
12572 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12573 level "admin".
12574
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012575enable server <backend>/<server>
12576 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12577 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12578
12579 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012580 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012581
12582 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12583 level "admin".
12584
12585get weight <backend>/<server>
12586 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12587 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12588 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12589 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12590 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012591 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012592
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012593help
12594 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12595 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012596
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012597prompt
12598 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12599 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12600 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12601 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12602 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12603 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12604 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12605 command.
12606
12607quit
12608 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012609
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012610set map <map> <key> <value>
12611 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12612 is <value>.
12613
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012614set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012615 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12616 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12617 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12618 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12619 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012620 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12621 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12622
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012623set maxconn global <maxconn>
12624 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12625 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12626 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12627 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12628 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12629 setting.
12630
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012631set rate-limit connections global <value>
12632 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12633 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12634 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12635 is passed in number of connections per second.
12636
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012637set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12638 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12639 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012640 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12641 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012642
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012643set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12644 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12645 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12646 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12647 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12648
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012649set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12650 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12651 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12652 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12653 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12654 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12655
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012656set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012657 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12658 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12659 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12660 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012661 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12662 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012663
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012664set timeout cli <delay>
12665 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12666 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12667 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12668
12669set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12670 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12671 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012672 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12673 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12674 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12675 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12676 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12677 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12678 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12679 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12680 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12681 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12682 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12683 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12684 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012685
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012686show errors [<iid>]
12687 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12688 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012689 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12690 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12691 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012692
12693 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12694 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12695 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12696 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12697 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12698 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12699 are reported too.
12700
12701 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12702 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12703 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12704 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12705 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12706 code.
12707
12708 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12709 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12710 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12711 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12712 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12713 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12714 line.
12715
12716 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012717 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12718 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012719 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12720 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12721
12722 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12723 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12724 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12725 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12726 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12727 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12728 00204+ minal\r\n
12729 00211 \r\n
12730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012731 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012732 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12733 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12734 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12735 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12736 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12737 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012738
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012739show info
12740 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12741
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012742show map [<map>]
12743 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12744 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12745
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010012746show pools
12747 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
12748 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
12749 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
12750 the pools.
12751
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012752show sess
12753 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012754 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12755 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12756
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012757show sess <id>
12758 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12759 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12760 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12761 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12762 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012763 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12764 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12765 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012766
12767show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12768 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12769 possible to dump only selected items :
12770 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12771 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12772 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12773 for example:
12774 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12775 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12776 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12777
12778 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012779 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12780 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012781 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12782 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12783 Nbproc: 1
12784 Process_num: 1
12785 (...)
12786
12787 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12788 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12789 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12790 (...)
12791 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12792
12793 $
12794
12795 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12796 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12797 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12798 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012799 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012800
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012801show table
12802 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12803 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12804 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12805 entries currently in use.
12806
12807 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012808 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012809 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12810 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012811
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012812show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012813 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12814 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12815 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012816 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12817
12818 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12819 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12820 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12821 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12822 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12823
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012824 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12825 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12826 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12827 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12828 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12829 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12830
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012831
12832 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012833 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12834 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012835
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012836 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012837 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012838 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012839 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12840 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12841 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12842 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012843
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012844 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012845 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012846 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12847 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012848
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012849 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12850 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012851 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012852 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12853 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012854
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012855 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12856 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012857 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012858 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12859 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12860
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012861 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12862 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12863 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12864 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12865 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12866
12867 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12868 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12869 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012870 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12871 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012872 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12873 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012874
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012875shutdown frontend <frontend>
12876 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12877 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12878 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12879 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12880 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12881 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12882 once it is terminated.
12883
12884 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12885 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12886
12887 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12888 level "admin".
12889
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012890shutdown session <id>
12891 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12892 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12893 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12894 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12895 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12896 flag in the logs.
12897
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012898shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12899 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12900 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12901 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12902 'K' flag in the logs.
12903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012904/*
12905 * Local variables:
12906 * fill-column: 79
12907 * End:
12908 */